blob: af71d09c4083fa0b69ca9c9ded7e5bc27b177357 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauad90f0d2015-06-17 15:53:25 +02007 2015/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
545 - 51degrees-property-seperator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200548 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200550 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100551 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100552 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100553 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200554 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200555 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200556 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - noepoll
558 - nokqueue
559 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100560 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300561 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200562 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200563 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200564 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100565 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100566 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200567 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100568 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100569 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100570 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100571 - tune.lua.session-timeout
572 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100573 - tune.maxaccept
574 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200575 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200576 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200577 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100578 - tune.rcvbuf.client
579 - tune.rcvbuf.server
580 - tune.sndbuf.client
581 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100582 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100583 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200584 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100585 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200586 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200587 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200588 - tune.vars.global-max-size
589 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
590 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
591 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100592 - tune.zlib.memlevel
593 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100594
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 * Debugging
596 - debug
597 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598
599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006003.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601------------------------------------
602
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200603ca-base <dir>
604 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200605 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
606 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608chroot <jail dir>
609 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
610 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
611 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
612 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
613 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
614 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100615
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100616cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
617 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
618 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
619 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100620 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
621 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
622 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
623 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
624 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
625 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
626 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
627 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
628 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
629 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100630
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200631crt-base <dir>
632 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
633 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
634 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636daemon
637 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
638 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
639 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
640
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200641deviceatlas-json-file <path>
642 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
643 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
644
645deviceatlas-log-level <value>
646 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
647 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
648
649deviceatlas-separator <char>
650 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
651 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
652
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900653external-check
654 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
655 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
656 See "option external-check".
657
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658gid <number>
659 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
660 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
661 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100662 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
663 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200664 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200666group <group name>
667 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
668 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100669
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200670log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
672 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100673 configured with "log global".
674
675 <address> can be one of:
676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100677 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100678 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
679 port).
680
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100681 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
682 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
683 port).
684
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100685 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
686 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
687 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
688 writeable).
689
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200690 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
691 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100692
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200693 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
694 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
695 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
696 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
697 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
698 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
699 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
700 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
701 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
702 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
703 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
704
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100705 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706
707 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
708 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
709 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
710
711 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200712 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
713 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
714 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
715 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
716 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
717 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200719 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100721log-send-hostname [<string>]
722 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
723 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
724 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
725 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
726 the logs.
727
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000728log-tag <string>
729 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
730 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
731 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100732 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000733
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100734lua-load <file>
735 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
736 used multiple times.
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738nbproc <number>
739 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
740 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
741 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
742 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
743 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
744
745pidfile <pidfile>
746 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
747 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
748 starting the process. See also "daemon".
749
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100750stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200751 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
752 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
753 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
754 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
755 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
756 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100757 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200758 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
759 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200760
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100761ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
763 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300764 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100765 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
766 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
767 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
768 "bind" keyword for more information.
769
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100770ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
772 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
773 keyword to see available options.
774
775 Example:
776 global
777 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
778
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100779ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
781 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300782 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100783 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
784 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
785 information.
786
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100787ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
789 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
790 keyword to see available options.
791
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200792ssl-dh-param-file <file>
793 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
794 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
795 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
796 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
797 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
798 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
799 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
800 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
801 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
802 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
803 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
804 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
805
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100806ssl-server-verify [none|required]
807 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
808 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
809 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
810
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200811stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
812 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
813 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
814 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
815 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200816
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200817 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
818 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
819 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200820
821stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
822 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
823 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100824 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200825
826stats maxconn <connections>
827 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
828 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
829
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200830uid <number>
831 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
832 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
833 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
834 one. See also "gid" and "user".
835
836ulimit-n <number>
837 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
838 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
839 option.
840
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100841unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
842 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
843
844 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
845 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
846 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
847 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
848 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
849 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
850 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
851 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
852 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
853 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
854
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855user <user name>
856 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
857 See also "uid" and "group".
858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200859node <name>
860 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
861
862 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
863 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
864 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
865 traffic.
866
867description <text>
868 Add a text that describes the instance.
869
870 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
871 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
872 "<" and ">" characters.
873
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010087451degrees-data-file <file path>
875 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
876 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
877
878 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
879 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
880
88151degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
882 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
883 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
884 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
885
886 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
887 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
888
88951degrees-property-seperator <char>
890 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
891 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
892
893 Please note that this options is only available when haproxy has been
894 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
895
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200898-----------------------
899
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200900max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
901 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
902 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
903 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
904 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
905 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
906 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
907 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
908 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200910maxconn <number>
911 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
912 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
913 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200914 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
915 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
916 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
917 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100918 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
919 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
920 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
921 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
922 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200924maxconnrate <number>
925 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
926 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
927 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
928 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
929 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
930 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
931 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
932 fairness.
933
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100934maxcomprate <number>
935 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300936 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100937 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
938 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
939 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
940 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
941 default value.
942
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100943maxcompcpuusage <number>
944 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
945 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
946 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
947 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
948 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
949 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
950 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
951 process down and from introducing high latencies.
952
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100953maxpipes <number>
954 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
955 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
956 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
957 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
958 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
959 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
960
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200961maxsessrate <number>
962 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
963 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
964 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
965 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
966 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
967 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
968 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
969 fairness.
970
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200971maxsslconn <number>
972 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
973 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
974 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
975 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
976 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
977 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
978 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100979 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
980 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
981 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
982 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
983 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
984 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
985 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200986
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200987maxsslrate <number>
988 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
989 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
990 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
991 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
992 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
993 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
994 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
995 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
996 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
997 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
998
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100999maxzlibmem <number>
1000 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1001 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1002 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001003 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1004 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1005 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007noepoll
1008 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1009 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001010 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001011
1012nokqueue
1013 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1014 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1015 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1016
1017nopoll
1018 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1019 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001020 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001021 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001022
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001023nosplice
1024 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1025 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1026 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001027 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001028 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1029 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1030 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1031 "option splice-response".
1032
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033nogetaddrinfo
1034 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1035 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1036
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001037spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001038 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1039 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1040 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1041 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1042 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1043 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001044
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001045tune.buffers.limit <number>
1046 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1047 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1048 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1049 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1050 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1051 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1052 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1053 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1054 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1055 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1056 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1057 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1058 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1059 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1060 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1061
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001062tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1063 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1064 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1065 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1066 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1067
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001068tune.bufsize <number>
1069 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1070 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1071 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1072 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1073 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1074 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1075 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1076 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001077 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1078 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1079 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001080
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001081tune.chksize <number>
1082 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1083 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1084 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1085 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1086 checks whenever possible.
1087
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001088tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1089 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1090 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1091 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1092 this value. The default value is 1.
1093
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001094tune.http.cookielen <number>
1095 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1096 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1097 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1098 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1099 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1100 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1101 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1102 to change this value.
1103
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001104tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1105 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1106 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1107 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1108 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1109 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1110 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1111 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1112 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1113 limit too high.
1114
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001115tune.idletimer <timeout>
1116 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1117 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1118 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1119 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1120 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1121 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1122 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1123 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1124 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1125
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001126tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1127 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1128 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1129 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1130 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1131 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1132 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1133 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1134
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001135tune.lua.maxmem
1136 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1137 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1138 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1139 memory.
1140
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001141tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1142 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1143 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1144 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1145 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1146 4s.
1147
1148tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1149 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1150 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1151 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1152 check servers.
1153
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001154tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001155 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1156 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1157 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1158 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1159 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1160 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1161 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1162 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1163 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1164 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001165
1166tune.maxpollevents <number>
1167 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1168 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1169 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1170 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1171 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1172
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001173tune.maxrewrite <number>
1174 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1175 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1176 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1177 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1178 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1179 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1180 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1181 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1182 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1183 bufsize.
1184
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001185tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1186 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1187 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1188 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1189 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1190 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1191 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1192 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1193 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1194 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1195 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1196 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1197 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1198 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1199 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1200 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1201 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1202 setting this parameter to 0.
1203
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001204tune.pipesize <number>
1205 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1206 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1207 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1208 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1209 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1210 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1211
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001212tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1213tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1214 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1215 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1216 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1217 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1218 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1219 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1220 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1221
1222tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1223tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1224 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1225 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1226 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1227 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1228 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1229 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1230 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1231 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1232 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1233 notifying haproxy again.
1234
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001235tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001236 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1237 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1238 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001239 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001240 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1241 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1242 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1243 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1244 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001245 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1246 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001247
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001248tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1249 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1250 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1251 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1252 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1253 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1254 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1255
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001256tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1257 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001258 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001259 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1260 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1261 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1262 being used for too long.
1263
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001264tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1265 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1266 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1267 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1268 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1269 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1270 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1271 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1272 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1273 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1274 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001275 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1276 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001277
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001278tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1279 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1280 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1281 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1282 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1283 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1284 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1285 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001286 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1287 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001288
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001289tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1290 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1291 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1292 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1293 1000 entries.
1294
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001295tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1296tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1297tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1298tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1299 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1300 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1301 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1302 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1303 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1304
1305 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1306 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1307 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1308 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1309
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001310tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1311 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001312 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001313 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1314 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1315 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1316
1317tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1318 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1319 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1320 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1321 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013233.3. Debugging
1324--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001325
1326debug
1327 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1328 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1329 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1330 system startup.
1331
1332quiet
1333 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1334 line argument "-q".
1335
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013373.4. Userlists
1338--------------
1339It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1340http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1341it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1342
1343userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001344 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001345 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1346
1347group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001348 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001349 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1350 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1351
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001352user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1353 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001354 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1355 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001356 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1357 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001358 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001359 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001360
1361
1362 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001363 userlist L1
1364 group G1 users tiger,scott
1365 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001366
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001367 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1368 user scott insecure-password elgato
1369 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001370
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001371 userlist L2
1372 group G1
1373 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001374
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001375 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1376 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1377 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001378
1379 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001380
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001381
13823.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001383----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001384It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1385several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1386instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1387values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1388automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1389In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1390using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1391tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1392reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1393Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1394that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1395each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001396
1397peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001398 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001399 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1400
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001401disabled
1402 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1403 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1404 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1405
1406enable
1407 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1408
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001409peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1410 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1411 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1412 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1413 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1414 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1415 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1416
1417 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1418 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1419
1420 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1421 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1422 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1423 across all peers.
1424
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001425 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1426 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001427
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001428 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001429 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001430 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1431 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1432 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001433
1434 backend mybackend
1435 mode tcp
1436 balance roundrobin
1437 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1438 stick on src
1439
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001440 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1441 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001442
1443
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014443.6. Mailers
1445------------
1446It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1447If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1448in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1449
1450mailer <mailersect>
1451 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1452 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1453
1454mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1455 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1456
1457 Example:
1458 mailers mymailers
1459 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1460 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1461
1462 backend mybackend
1463 mode tcp
1464 balance roundrobin
1465
1466 email-alert mailers mymailers
1467 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1468 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1469
1470 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1471 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1472
1473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014744. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001477Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001478 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001479 - frontend <name>
1480 - backend <name>
1481 - listen <name>
1482
1483A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1484its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1485section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001486section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001487
1488A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1489connections.
1490
1491A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1492to forward incoming connections.
1493
1494A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1495parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1496
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001497All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1498'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1499case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1500
1501Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1502logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1503proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1504However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1505name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1506
1507Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1508and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001509bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001510protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1511modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1512arbitrary criteria.
1513
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001514In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1515a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1516the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1517
1518 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1519 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1520 between responses and new requests.
1521
1522 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1523 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1524 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1525 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1526
1527 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1528 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1529 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1530
1531 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1532 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1533 client-facing connection remains open.
1534
1535 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1536 after the end of the response.
1537
1538The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1539frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1540following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1541weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1542
1543 Backend mode
1544
1545 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1546 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1547 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1548 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1549 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1550 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1551 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1552 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1553 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1554 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1555 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001557
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1560--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001562The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1563limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1564they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1565limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001566marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001567option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001568and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1569with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1570specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001572
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001573 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1574------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1575acl - X X X
1576appsession - - X X
1577backlog X X X -
1578balance X - X X
1579bind - X X -
1580bind-process X X X X
1581block - X X X
1582capture cookie - X X -
1583capture request header - X X -
1584capture response header - X X -
1585clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001586compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001587contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1588cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001589declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001590default-server X - X X
1591default_backend X X X -
1592description - X X X
1593disabled X X X X
1594dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001595email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001596email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001597email-alert mailers X X X X
1598email-alert myhostname X X X X
1599email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001600enabled X X X X
1601errorfile X X X X
1602errorloc X X X X
1603errorloc302 X X X X
1604-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1605errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001606force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001607fullconn X - X X
1608grace X X X X
1609hash-type X - X X
1610http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001611http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001612http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001613http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001614http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001615http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001616id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001617ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001618log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001619log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001620log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001621max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001622maxconn X X X -
1623mode X X X X
1624monitor fail - X X -
1625monitor-net X X X -
1626monitor-uri X X X -
1627option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1628option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1629option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1630option allbackups (*) X - X X
1631option checkcache (*) X - X X
1632option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1633option contstats (*) X X X -
1634option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1635option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1636option forceclose (*) X X X X
1637-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1638option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001639option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001640option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001641option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001642option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001643option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001644option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001645option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001646option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1647option httpchk X - X X
1648option httpclose (*) X X X X
1649option httplog X X X X
1650option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001651option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001652option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001653option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001654option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1655option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1656option logasap (*) X X X -
1657option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001658option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001659option nolinger (*) X X X X
1660option originalto X X X X
1661option persist (*) X - X X
1662option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001663option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001664option smtpchk X - X X
1665option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1666option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1667option splice-request (*) X X X X
1668option splice-response (*) X X X X
1669option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1670option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1671-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001672option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001673option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1674option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1675option tcpka X X X X
1676option tcplog X X X X
1677option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001678external-check command X - X X
1679external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001680persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1681rate-limit sessions X X X -
1682redirect - X X X
1683redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1684redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1685reqadd - X X X
1686reqallow - X X X
1687reqdel - X X X
1688reqdeny - X X X
1689reqiallow - X X X
1690reqidel - X X X
1691reqideny - X X X
1692reqipass - X X X
1693reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001694reqitarpit - X X X
1695reqpass - X X X
1696reqrep - X X X
1697-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001698reqtarpit - X X X
1699retries X - X X
1700rspadd - X X X
1701rspdel - X X X
1702rspdeny - X X X
1703rspidel - X X X
1704rspideny - X X X
1705rspirep - X X X
1706rsprep - X X X
1707server - - X X
1708source X - X X
1709srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001710stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001711stats auth X - X X
1712stats enable X - X X
1713stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001714stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001715stats realm X - X X
1716stats refresh X - X X
1717stats scope X - X X
1718stats show-desc X - X X
1719stats show-legends X - X X
1720stats show-node X - X X
1721stats uri X - X X
1722-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1723stick match - - X X
1724stick on - - X X
1725stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001726stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001727stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001728tcp-check connect - - X X
1729tcp-check expect - - X X
1730tcp-check send - - X X
1731tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001732tcp-request connection - X X -
1733tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001734tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001735tcp-response content - - X X
1736tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737timeout check X - X X
1738timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001739timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001740timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1741timeout connect X - X X
1742timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1743timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1744timeout http-request X X X X
1745timeout queue X - X X
1746timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001747timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001748timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1749timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001750timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001751transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001752unique-id-format X X X -
1753unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001754use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001755use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001756------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1757 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1761---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762
1763This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1764
1765
1766acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1767 Declare or complete an access list.
1768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1769 no | yes | yes | yes
1770 Example:
1771 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1772 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1773 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001775 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776
1777
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001778appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1779 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1782 no | no | yes | yes
1783 Arguments :
1784 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1785 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1786
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001787 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001788 checked in each cookie value.
1789
1790 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1791 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1792 milliseconds.
1793
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001794 request-learn
1795 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1796 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1797 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1798 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1799 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1800 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1801
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001802 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1803 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1804 data following this prefix.
1805
1806 Example :
1807 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1808
1809 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1810 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1811
1812 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1813 2 modes are currently supported :
1814 - path-parameters :
1815 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1816 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1817 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1818 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1819 - query-string :
1820 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1821 query string.
1822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1824 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1825 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1826 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001827 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1828 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1829 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1831 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1832
1833 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1834
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001835 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1836 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1837 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1838
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 Example :
1840 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1841
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001842 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1843 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844
1845
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001846backlog <conns>
1847 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1849 yes | yes | yes | no
1850 Arguments :
1851 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1852 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001853 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001854
1855 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1856 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1857 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1858 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1859 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1860 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1861 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1862 backlog parameter.
1863
1864 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1865 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1866 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1867
1868 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1869
1870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001872balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1875 yes | no | yes | yes
1876 Arguments :
1877 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1878 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1879 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1880 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1881
1882 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1883 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1884 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1885 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001886 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001887 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001888 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1889 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1890 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1891 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1892 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1893 it, so that you don't worry.
1894
1895 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1896 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1897 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1898 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1899 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1900 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1901 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1902 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001903
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001904 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1905 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1906 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1907 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1908 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1909 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1910 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1911 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1912
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001913 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001914 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001915 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1916 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001917 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001918 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1919 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1920 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1921 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1922 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001923 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1924 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1925 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1926 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1927 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1928 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001930 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1931 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1932 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1933 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1934 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1935 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1936 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1937 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001938 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001939 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001940 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1941 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1942 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001944 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1945 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1946 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1947 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1948 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1949 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1950 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1951 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1952 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1953 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1954 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1955 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001957 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001958 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1959 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1960 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1961 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1962 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1963 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1964 URIs start with a leading "/".
1965
1966 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1967 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1968 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1969 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001971 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001972 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1973
1974 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001975 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1976 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001977 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1978 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1979 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1980 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001981 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001982 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1983 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001984
1985 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1986 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1987 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1988 server will receive the request.
1989
1990 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1991 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1992 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1993 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1994 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001995 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1996 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1997 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001999 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2000 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2001 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2002 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2003 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002005 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002006 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2007 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2008 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2009
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002010 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2011 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2012 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2013
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002014 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002015 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002016 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2017 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2018 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2019 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2020 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2021 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002022 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002023 used instead.
2024
2025 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2026 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2027 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2028 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2029
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002030 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2031 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2032 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2033
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002034 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002036 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002037 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2038 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002039
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002040 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2041 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2042 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
2044 Examples :
2045 balance roundrobin
2046 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002047 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002048 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2049 balance hdr(host)
2050 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002051
2052 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2053 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002055 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002056 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2057 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2058 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2059 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2060
2061 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2062 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2063 defaults to 16 kB.
2064
2065 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2066 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2067
2068 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2069 Round Robin.
2070
2071 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2072 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2073 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2074 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2075
2076 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2077
2078 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002079 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002080 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2081 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2082 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002084 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2085 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
2087
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002088bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2089bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2092 no | yes | yes | no
2093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002094 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2095 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2096 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2097 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002098 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002099 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2100 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2101 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2102 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2103 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2104 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2105 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002106 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2107 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2108 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2109 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2110 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2111 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2112 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002113 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2114 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2115 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002116 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2117 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2118 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002119
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002120 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2121 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002122 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2123 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2124 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002125 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2126 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2127 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2128 the range.
2129
2130 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2131 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2132 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2133 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2134 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2135 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2136 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002137 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002138 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002140 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2141 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2142 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2143 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2144 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2145 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2146 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2147 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2148
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002149 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2150 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2151 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2152 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2155 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2156 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2157 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2158 in a frontend.
2159
2160 Example :
2161 listen http_proxy
2162 bind :80,:443
2163 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002164 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002166 listen http_https_proxy
2167 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002168 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002169
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002170 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2171 bind ipv6@:80
2172 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2173 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2174
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002175 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002176 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002177
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002178 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002179 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002180
2181
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002182bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002183 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2185 yes | yes | yes | yes
2186 Arguments :
2187 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2188 may be used to override a default value.
2189
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002190 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002191 option may be combined with other numbers.
2192
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002193 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002194 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2195 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2196 missing from all processes.
2197
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002198 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002199 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002200 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2201 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2202 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2203 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002204
2205 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2206 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2207 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2208 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2209 and 'even' instances.
2210
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002211 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2212 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2213 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2214 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002215
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002216 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2217 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2218
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002219 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2220 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2221 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2222
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002223 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2224 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2225
2226 Example :
2227 listen app_ip1
2228 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002229 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002230
2231 listen app_ip2
2232 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002233 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002234
2235 listen management
2236 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002237 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002238
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002239 listen management
2240 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2241 bind-process 1-4
2242
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002243 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002244
2245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246block { if | unless } <condition>
2247 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 no | yes | yes | yes
2250
2251 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2252 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002253 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002254 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2256 "block" statements per instance.
2257
2258 Example:
2259 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2260 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2261 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2262 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002264 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265
2266
2267capture cookie <name> len <length>
2268 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2270 no | yes | yes | no
2271 Arguments :
2272 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2273 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2274 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2275 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2276 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2277
2278 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2279 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2280 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2281 right if it exceeds <length>.
2282
2283 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2284 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2285 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2286 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2287
2288 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2289 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2290 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2291
2292 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2293 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2294 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002295 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2296 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2297 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298
2299 Example:
2300 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2301
2302 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002303 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
2305
2306capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002307 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2309 no | yes | yes | no
2310 Arguments :
2311 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002312 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2314 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2315 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2316
2317 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2318 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2319 it exceeds <length>.
2320
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002321 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2323 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002324 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2325 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2326 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2327 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002328 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002329 environments to find where the request came from.
2330
2331 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2332 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2333 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2334 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002336 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2337 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2338 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2339 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2340 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341
2342 Example:
2343 capture request header Host len 15
2344 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2345 capture request header Referrer len 15
2346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002347 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348 about logging.
2349
2350
2351capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002352 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2354 no | yes | yes | no
2355 Arguments :
2356 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002357 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2359 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2360 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2361
2362 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2363 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2364 it exceeds <length>.
2365
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002366 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2368 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2369 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002370 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2371 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2372 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2373 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002375 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2376 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2377 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2378 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2379 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
2381 Example:
2382 capture response header Content-length len 9
2383 capture response header Location len 15
2384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002385 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386 about logging.
2387
2388
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002389clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2392 yes | yes | yes | no
2393 Arguments :
2394 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2395 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2396 as explained at the top of this document.
2397
2398 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2399 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2400 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2401 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2402 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2403 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2404 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2405 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002406 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2408 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2409
2410 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2411 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2412 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2413 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2414 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2415 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2416
2417 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2418 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2419
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002420 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2421 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002423compression algo <algorithm> ...
2424compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002425compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002426 Enable HTTP compression.
2427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2428 yes | yes | yes | yes
2429 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002430 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2431 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2432 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2433
2434 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002435 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2436 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2437 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002438
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002439 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2440 support for zlib was built in.
2441
2442 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2443 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2444 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2445 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2446 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2447 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002448
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002449 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2450 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2451 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2452 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2453 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2454 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2455 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2456 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002457
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002458 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002459 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002460 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2461 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2462 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2463 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2464 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002465
2466 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2467 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2468 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2469 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2470 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002471 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2472 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2473 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2474 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2475 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002476 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2477 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002478
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002479 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002480 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2481 "Accept-Encoding" header
2482 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002483 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002484 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2485 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002486 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2487 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2488 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2489 "multipart"
2490 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2491 header
2492 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2493 and later
2494 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2495 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002496
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002497 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2498 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002499
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002500 Examples :
2501 compression algo gzip
2502 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002504contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2507 yes | no | yes | yes
2508 Arguments :
2509 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2511 as explained at the top of this document.
2512
2513 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002514 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002515 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2517 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2518 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2519 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2520
2521 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2522 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2523 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2524 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2525 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2526 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2527
2528 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2529 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2530 instead.
2531
2532 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2533 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2534
2535
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002536cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002537 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2538 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002539 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2541 yes | no | yes | yes
2542 Arguments :
2543 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2544 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2545 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2546 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2547 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2548 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2549 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2550 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2551 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2552
2553 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2554 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2555 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2556 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2557 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2558 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2559 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2560 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2561 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2562 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2563 "insert" and "prefix".
2564
2565 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002566 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002567
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002568 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002569 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2570 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2571 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2572 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2573 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2574 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2575 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2576 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2577 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2578 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579
2580 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2581 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2582 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2583 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2584 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2585 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2586 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2587 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2588 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2589 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002590 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2591 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2592 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002594 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2595 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2596 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002597 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2598 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2599 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2600 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002601 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2602 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2603 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
2605 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2606 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2607 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2608 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2609 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2610 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2611 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2612 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2613 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2614
2615 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2616 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2617 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2618 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2619 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2620 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2621 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2622 persistence cookie in the cache.
2623 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2624
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002625 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2626 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2627 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2628 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2629 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2630 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2631 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2632 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2633 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2634 they logout.
2635
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002636 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2637 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2638 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2639 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2640
2641 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2642 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2643 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2644 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2645 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2646 this attribute.
2647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002648 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002649 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002650 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2651 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2652 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2653 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2654 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2655 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002656
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002657 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2658 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2659 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2660 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2661 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2662 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2663 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2664 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2665 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2666 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2667 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2668 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2669 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2670 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2671 the site.
2672
2673 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2674 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2675 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2676 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2677 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2678 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2679 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2680 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2681 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2682 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2683 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2684 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2685 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2686 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2687 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2688 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2691 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2692 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2693 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002695 Examples :
2696 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2697 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2698 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002699 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002701 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002702 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002704
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002705declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2706 Declares a capture slot.
2707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2708 no | yes | yes | no
2709 Arguments:
2710 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2711
2712 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2713 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2714 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2715 for use in the response.
2716
2717 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2718 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2719
2720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002721default-server [param*]
2722 Change default options for a server in a backend
2723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2724 yes | no | yes | yes
2725 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002726 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2727 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2728 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2729 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002730
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002731 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002732 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2733
2734 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737default_backend <backend>
2738 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2740 yes | yes | yes | no
2741 Arguments :
2742 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2743
2744 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2745 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2746 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2747 will catch all undetermined requests.
2748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749 Example :
2750
2751 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2752 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2753 default_backend dynamic
2754
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002755 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002758description <string>
2759 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2761 no | yes | yes | yes
2762 Arguments : string
2763
2764 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2765 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2766 it describes.
2767 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2768
2769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770disabled
2771 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2773 yes | yes | yes | yes
2774 Arguments : none
2775
2776 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2777 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2778 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2779 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2780 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2781 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2782 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2783
2784 See also : "enabled"
2785
2786
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002787dispatch <address>:<port>
2788 Set a default server address
2789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2790 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002791 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002792
2793 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2794 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2795 during start-up.
2796
2797 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2798 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2799 possible with normal servers.
2800
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002801 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002802 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2803 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2804 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2805 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2806
2807 See also : "server"
2808
2809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810enabled
2811 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2813 yes | yes | yes | yes
2814 Arguments : none
2815
2816 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2817 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2818
2819 See also : "disabled"
2820
2821
2822errorfile <code> <file>
2823 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2825 yes | yes | yes | yes
2826 Arguments :
2827 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002828 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2829 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
2831 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002832 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002833 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002834 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2835 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836
2837 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2838 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2839 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2840
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002841 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2844 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2845 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2846 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2847
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002848 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2849 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2850 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2851 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2852 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2853 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2854
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002855 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2856 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2857 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002858 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2860
2861 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2862
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002863 Example :
2864 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002865 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002866 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2867 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2868
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002869
2870errorloc <code> <url>
2871errorloc302 <code> <url>
2872 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2874 yes | yes | yes | yes
2875 Arguments :
2876 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002877 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002878
2879 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2880 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2881 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2882 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2883 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2884
2885 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2886 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2887 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2888
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002889 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2890
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002891 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2892 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2893 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2894 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2895 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2896 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2897 request.
2898
2899 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2900
2901
2902errorloc303 <code> <url>
2903 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2905 yes | yes | yes | yes
2906 Arguments :
2907 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2908 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2909
2910 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2911 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2912 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2913 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2914 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2915
2916 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2917 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2918 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2919
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002920 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2921
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002922 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2923 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2924 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2925 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002926 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002927
2928 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2929
2930
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002931email-alert from <emailaddr>
2932 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2933 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2935 yes | yes | yes | yes
2936
2937 Arguments :
2938
2939 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2940
2941 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2942 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2943
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002944 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2945 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2946
2947
2948email-alert level <level>
2949 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2950 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2952 yes | yes | yes | yes
2953
2954 Arguments :
2955
2956 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2957 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2958 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2959
2960 By default level is alert
2961
2962 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2963 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2964 for the proxy.
2965
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002966 Alerts are sent when :
2967
2968 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2969 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2970 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2971 is notice or lower
2972 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2973 and a health check status update occurs
2974
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002975 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2976 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002977 section 3.6 about mailers.
2978
2979
2980email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2981 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2983 yes | yes | yes | yes
2984
2985 Arguments :
2986
2987 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2988
2989 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2990 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2993 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002994
2995
2996email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2997 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2998 mailers.
2999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 yes | yes | yes | yes
3001
3002 Arguments :
3003
3004 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3005
3006 By default the systems hostname is used.
3007
3008 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3009 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3010 for the proxy.
3011
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003012 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3013 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003014
3015
3016email-alert to <emailaddr>
3017 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3018 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3020 yes | yes | yes | yes
3021
3022 Arguments :
3023
3024 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3025
3026 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3027 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3028
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003029 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003030 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3031
3032
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003033force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3034 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3036 no | yes | yes | yes
3037
3038 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3039 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3040 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3041 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3042 marked down for maintenance operations.
3043
3044 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3045 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3046 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3047 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3048 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3049 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3050 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3051 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3052 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3053
3054 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3055 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3056 is used.
3057
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003058 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003059 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003060
3061
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003062fullconn <conns>
3063 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3065 yes | no | yes | yes
3066 Arguments :
3067 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3068 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3069
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003070 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003071 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003072 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003073 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3074 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3075 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3076 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3077 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003078 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003079
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003080 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3081 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003082 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3083 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3084 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003085
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003086 Example :
3087 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3088 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3089 # connections.
3090 backend dynamic
3091 fullconn 10000
3092 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3093 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3094
3095 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3096
3097
3098grace <time>
3099 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003101 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003102 Arguments :
3103 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3104 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3105 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3106
3107 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3108 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003109 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003110 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3111
3112 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3113 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3114 simplify it.
3115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003117hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003118 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3120 yes | no | yes | yes
3121 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003122 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3123 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003124
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003125 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3126 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3127 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3128 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3129 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3130 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3131 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3132 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3133 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3134 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003135
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003136 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3137 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3138 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3139 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3140 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3141 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3142 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3143 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3144 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3145 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3146 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3147 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3148 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003149 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3150 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003151
3152 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3153
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003154 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003155 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3156 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3157 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003158 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3159 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3160 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003161
3162 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3163 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003164 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3165 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3166 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3167 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3168
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003169 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3170 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3171 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3172 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3173 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3174 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3175 parameter.
3176
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003177 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3178 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3179 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3180 used on strings.
3181
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003182 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3183
3184 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3185 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3186 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3187 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3188 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3189 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3190 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3191 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3192 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3193 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3194 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3195 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003196
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003197 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3198 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3199 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003200
3201 See also : "balance", "server"
3202
3203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204http-check disable-on-404
3205 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208 Arguments : none
3209
3210 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3211 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3212 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3213 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3214 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3215 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3216 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3217 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003218 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3219 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3220 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3221
3222 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3223
3224
3225http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003226 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003228 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003229 Arguments :
3230 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3231 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003232 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003233 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3234 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3235 details on the supported keywords.
3236
3237 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3238 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3239 with the usual backslash ('\').
3240
3241 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3242 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3243 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3244 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3245 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3246
3247 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003248 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003249 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3250 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3251 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3252
3253 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003254 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003255 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3256 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3257 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3258 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3259
3260 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003261 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003262 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3263 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3264 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3265 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3266 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3267 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3268 trace).
3269
3270 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003272 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3273 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3274 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3275 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3276 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3277 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3278
3279 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3280 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3281 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3282 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3283 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3284 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3285 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3286 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3287
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003288 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3289 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3290 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3291
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003292 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3293 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3294
3295 Examples :
3296 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003297 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003298
3299 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003300 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003301
3302 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003303 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003304
3305 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003306 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003307
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003308 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003309
3310
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003311http-check send-state
3312 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3314 yes | no | yes | yes
3315 Arguments : none
3316
3317 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3318 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3319 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3320 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3321 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3322
3323 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3324 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3325 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3326 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3327 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003328 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3329 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3330 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3331
3332 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3333 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3334 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3335
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003336 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3337 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3338 checked in multiple backends.
3339
3340 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3341 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3342
3343 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3344 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3345 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3346 one fails.
3347
3348 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3349 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3350 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3351
3352 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3353 server's queue.
3354
3355 Example of a header received by the application server :
3356 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3357 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3358
3359 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3360
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003361http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003362 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003363 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003364 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003365 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3366 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003367 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3368 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003369 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3370 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3371 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003372 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003373 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003374 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3375 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003376 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003378 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3379
3380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3381 no | yes | yes | yes
3382
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003383 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3384 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3385 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3386 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3387 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003388
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003389 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3390 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3391 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3392
3393 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3394 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3395 are evaluated.
3396
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003397 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3398 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3399 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3400 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3401 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3402 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3403 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3404 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3405 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003406 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003407 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3408
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003409 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3410 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3411 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3412 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3413 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3414
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003415 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3416 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3417 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003418 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3419 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003420
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003421 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3422 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3423 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3424 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3425 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3426 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3427 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3428 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3429
3430 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3431 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3432 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003433 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3434 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003435
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003436 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3437 <name>.
3438
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003439 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3440 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3441 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3442 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3443 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3444 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3445 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3446 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3447
3448 Example:
3449
3450 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3451
3452 applied to:
3453
3454 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3455
3456 outputs:
3457
3458 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3459
3460 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3461
3462 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3463 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3464 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3465 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3466 header.
3467
3468 Example:
3469
3470 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3471
3472 applied to:
3473
3474 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3475
3476 outputs:
3477
3478 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3479
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003480 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3481 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3482 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3483 it.
3484
3485 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3486 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3487 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3488 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3489 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3490 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3491
3492 Example :
3493 # prepend the host name before the path
3494 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3495
3496 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3497 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3498 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3499 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3500 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3501 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3502 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3503 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3504
3505 Example :
3506 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3507 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3508
3509 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3510 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3511 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3512 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3513 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3514 "set-query".
3515
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003516 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3517 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3518 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3519 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3520 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3521 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3522 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3523 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3524
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003525 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3526 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3527 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3528 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3529 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3530 another equipment.
3531
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003532 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3533 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3534 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3535 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3536 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3537 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3538 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3539 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3540
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003541 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3542 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3543 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3544 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3545 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3546 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3547 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3548 admin privileges.
3549
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003550 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3551 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3552 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3553 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3554 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3555 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3556 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3557 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3558
3559 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3560 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3561 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3562 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3563 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3564 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3565
3566 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3567 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3568 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3569 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3570 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3571 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3572
3573 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3574 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3575 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3576 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3577 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3578 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3579 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3580 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3581 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3582
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003583 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003584 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3585 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3586 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3587 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3588 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3589 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3590 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3591 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3592 request header" for more information.
3593
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003594 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3595 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3596 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3597 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3598
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003599 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3600 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3601 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3602 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3603 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3604 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3605 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3606 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3607 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3608 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3609 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3610 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3611
3612 These actions take one or two arguments :
3613 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3614 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3615 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3616 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3617
3618 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3619 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3620 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3621 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3622
3623 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3624 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3625 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3626 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3627 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3628 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3629 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3630 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3631
3632 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3633 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3634 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3635 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3636 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3637
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003638 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3639 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3640 function is documented in the API documentation.
3641
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003642 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3643 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3644 inline.
3645
3646 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3647 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3648 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3649 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3650 (request and response)
3651 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3652 processing
3653 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3654 processing.
3655 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3656 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3657 and '_'.
3658
3659 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3660 followed by some converters.
3661
3662 Example:
3663
3664 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3665
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003666 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3667
3668 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3669 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3670 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3671 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003672
3673 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003674 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3675 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3676 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003677
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003678 http-request allow if nagios
3679 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3680 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3681 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003682
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003683 Example:
3684 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003685 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003686
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003687 Example:
3688 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3689 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3690 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3691 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3692 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3693 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3694 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3695 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3696 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3697
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003698 Example:
3699 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3700 acl add path /addacl
3701 acl del path /delacl
3702
3703 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3704
3705 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3706 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3707
3708 Example:
3709 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3710 acl setmap path /setmap
3711 acl delmap path /delmap
3712
3713 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3714
3715 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3716 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3717
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003718 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3719 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003720
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003721http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003722 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003723 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003724 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3725 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003726 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3727 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3728 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3729 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003730 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003731 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003732 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003733 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003734 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003735 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3736
3737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 no | yes | yes | yes
3739
3740 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3741 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3742 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3743 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3744 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3745 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3746
3747 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3748 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3749 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3750 current section.
3751
3752 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3753 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3754 rules are evaluated.
3755
3756 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3757 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3758 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3759 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3760 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3761 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3762 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3763
3764 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3765 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3766 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3767 external users.
3768
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003769 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3770 <name>.
3771
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003772 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3773 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3774 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3775 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3776 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3777 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3778 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3779 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3780
3781 Example:
3782
3783 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3784
3785 applied to:
3786
3787 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3788
3789 outputs:
3790
3791 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3792
3793 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3794
3795 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3796 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3797 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3798 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3799 header.
3800
3801 Example:
3802
3803 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3804
3805 applied to:
3806
3807 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3808
3809 outputs:
3810
3811 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3812
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003813 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3814 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3815 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3816 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3817 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3818 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3819 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3820 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3821
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003822 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3823 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3824 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3825 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3826 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3827 another equipment.
3828
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003829 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3830 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3831 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3832 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3833 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3834 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3835 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3836 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3837
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003838 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3839 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3840 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3841 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3842 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3843 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3844 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3845 admin privileges.
3846
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003847 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3848 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3849 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3850 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3851 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3852 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3853 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3854 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3855
3856 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3857 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3858 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3859 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3860 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3861 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3862
3863 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3864 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3865 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3866 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3867 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3868 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3869
3870 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3871 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3872 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3873 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3874 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3875 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3876 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3877 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3878 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3879
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003880 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3881 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3882 function is documented in the API documentation.
3883
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003884 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3885 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3886 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3887 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3888 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3889 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3890 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3891 response header" for more information.
3892
3893 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3894 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3895 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3896 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3897 keyword.
3898
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003899 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3900 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3901 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3902 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3903 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3904 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3905
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003906 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
3907 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3908 inline.
3909
3910 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3911 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3912 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3913 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3914 (request and response)
3915 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3916 processing
3917 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3918 processing.
3919 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3920 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3921 and '_'.
3922
3923 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3924 followed by some converters.
3925
3926 Example:
3927
3928 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
3929
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003930 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3931
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003932 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003933 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3934 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3935 rules.
3936
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003937 Example:
3938 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3939
3940 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3941
3942 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3943 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3944
3945 Example:
3946 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3947
3948 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3949
3950 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3951 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3952
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003953 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3954 ACL usage.
3955
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003956
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003957http-send-name-header [<header>]
3958 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3959
3960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3961 yes | no | yes | yes
3962
3963 Arguments :
3964
3965 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3966
3967 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3968 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3969 is added with the header string proved.
3970
3971 See also : "server"
3972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003973id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003974 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3976 no | yes | yes | yes
3977 Arguments : none
3978
3979 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3980 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3981 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003982
3983
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003984ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3985 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3986 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 no | yes | yes | yes
3988
3989 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3990 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3991 and running).
3992
3993 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3994 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3995 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003996 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003997 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3998
3999 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
4000 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
4001
4002 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4003 "unless" condition is met.
4004
4005 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4006
4007
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004008log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004009log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004010no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004011 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004014
4015 Prefix :
4016 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4017 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4018 prefix does not allow arguments.
4019
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004020 Arguments :
4021 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4022 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4023 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4024 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4025 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4026 parameter.
4027
4028 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4029 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4030
4031 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4032 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4033 standard syslog port).
4034
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004035 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4036 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4037 standard syslog port).
4038
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004039 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4040 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4041 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4042 appropriately writeable).
4043
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004044 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4045 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004046
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004047 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4048 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4049 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4050 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4051 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4052 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4053 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4054 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4055 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4056 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4057 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4058
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004059 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4060
4061 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4062 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4063 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4064
4065 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4066 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4067 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004068 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4069 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4070 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4071 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4072 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004073
4074 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4075
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004076 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4077 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4078 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004079
4080 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4081 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4082 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4083 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4084
4085 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4086 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004087
4088 Example :
4089 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004090 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4091 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004092 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004093
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004094
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004095log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004096 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4097 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004099
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004100 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4101 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4102 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4103 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4104 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004105
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004106log-tag <string>
4107 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | yes | yes | yes
4110
4111 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4112 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4113 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4114 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4115 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4116 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4117 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4118 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4119 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004120
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004121max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4122 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4123 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | no | yes | yes
4125
4126 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4127 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4128 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4129 servers.
4130
4131 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4132 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4133 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4134 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4135 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4136 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4137 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4138 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4139 picking a different server.
4140
4141 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4142 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4143 even if they have to be queued.
4144
4145 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4146 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4147
4148
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004149maxconn <conns>
4150 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4152 yes | yes | yes | no
4153 Arguments :
4154 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4155 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4156 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4157 closes.
4158
4159 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4160 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4161 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4162 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4163 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4164 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4165 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4166 properly tuned.
4167
4168 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4169 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4170 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4171
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004172 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004174 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4175
4176
4177mode { tcp|http|health }
4178 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 yes | yes | yes | yes
4181 Arguments :
4182 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4183 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4184 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4185 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4186
4187 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4188 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4189 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4190 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4191 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4192
4193 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004194 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4195 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4196 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4197 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4198 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4199 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4200 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004201
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004202 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4203 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4204 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004205
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004206 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004207 defaults http_instances
4208 mode http
4209
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004210 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004211
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004213monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004217 Arguments :
4218 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4219 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004220 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004221 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4222 backend and its backup.
4223
4224 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4225 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4226 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4227 servers in a list of backends.
4228
4229 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4230 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4231 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4232 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4233 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4234 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4235 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004236 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4237 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004238
4239 Example:
4240 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004241 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4243 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4244 monitor-uri /site_alive
4245 monitor fail if site_dead
4246
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004247 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004248
4249
4250monitor-net <source>
4251 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4253 yes | yes | yes | no
4254 Arguments :
4255 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4256 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4257 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4258 followed by a mask.
4259
4260 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4261 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004262 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004263 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4264
4265 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4266 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4267 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4268 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004269 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4270 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4271 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004272
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004273 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4274 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4275 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4276 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4277 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4278 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004279
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004280 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4281 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004282
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004283 Example :
4284 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4285 frontend www
4286 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4287
4288 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4289
4290
4291monitor-uri <uri>
4292 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4294 yes | yes | yes | no
4295 Arguments :
4296 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4297 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4298
4299 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4300 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4301 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4302 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4303 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4304 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4305 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4306 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4307
4308 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4309 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4310 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4311 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4312 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4313 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4314
4315 Example :
4316 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4317 frontend www
4318 mode http
4319 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4320
4321 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004324option abortonclose
4325no option abortonclose
4326 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 yes | no | yes | yes
4329 Arguments : none
4330
4331 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4332 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4333 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4334 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004335 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004336 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4337 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4338 encountered while delivering the response.
4339
4340 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4341 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4342 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4343 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4344 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4345 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004346 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004347 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004348 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004349 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4350 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4351 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4352
4353 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4354 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4355 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4356 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4357 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4358 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4359 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4360 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004361 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004362
4363 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4364 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4365
4366 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4367
4368
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004369option accept-invalid-http-request
4370no option accept-invalid-http-request
4371 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 yes | yes | yes | no
4374 Arguments : none
4375
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004376 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004377 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4378 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4379 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4380 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4381 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4382 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4383 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004384 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4385 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4386 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4387 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4388 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004389 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004390 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4391 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4392 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004393
4394 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4395 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4396 been confirmed.
4397
4398 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4399 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004400 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4401 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004402 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4403
4404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4406
4407 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4408 stats socket.
4409
4410
4411option accept-invalid-http-response
4412no option accept-invalid-http-response
4413 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4415 yes | no | yes | yes
4416 Arguments : none
4417
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004418 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004419 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4420 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4421 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4422 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4423 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4424 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4425 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004426 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4427 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4428 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004429
4430 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4431 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4432 been confirmed.
4433
4434 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4435 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4436 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4437 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4438
4439 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4440 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4441
4442 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4443 stats socket.
4444
4445
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004446option allbackups
4447no option allbackups
4448 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4450 yes | no | yes | yes
4451 Arguments : none
4452
4453 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4454 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4455 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4456 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4457 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4458 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4459 order between the backup servers anymore.
4460
4461 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4462 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4463
4464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4466
4467
4468option checkcache
4469no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004470 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4472 yes | no | yes | yes
4473 Arguments : none
4474
4475 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4476 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004477 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004478 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4479 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004480 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004481
4482 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004483 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004484 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004485 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4486 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004487 to the client are :
4488 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004489 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004490 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004491 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4492 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4493 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4494 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4495 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4496 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4497 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4498 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4499 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4500 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4501 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4502
4503 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004504 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004505 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004506 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004507 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4508
4509 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4510 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004511 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004512 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4513
4514 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4515 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4516
4517
4518option clitcpka
4519no option clitcpka
4520 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | no
4523 Arguments : none
4524
4525 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4526 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4527 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4528 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4529
4530 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4531 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4532 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4533 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4534
4535 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4536 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4537 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4538 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4539 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4540
4541 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4542
4543 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4544 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4545 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4546
4547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4549
4550 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4551
4552
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004553option contstats
4554 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4556 yes | yes | yes | no
4557 Arguments : none
4558
4559 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4560 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4561 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4562 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4563 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4564 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4565 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4566
4567
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004568option dontlog-normal
4569no option dontlog-normal
4570 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4572 yes | yes | yes | no
4573 Arguments : none
4574
4575 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4576 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4577 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4578 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4579 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4580 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4581 logged.
4582
4583 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4584 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4585 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004587 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004588 logging.
4589
4590
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004591option dontlognull
4592no option dontlognull
4593 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | yes | yes | no
4596 Arguments : none
4597
4598 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4599 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4600 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4601 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4602 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4603 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004604 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4605 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4606 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004607
4608 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4609 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4610 would not be logged.
4611
4612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4614
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004615 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4616 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004617
4618
4619option forceclose
4620no option forceclose
4621 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004623 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004624 Arguments : none
4625
4626 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4627 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4628 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4629 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4630 global session times in the logs.
4631
4632 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004633 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004634 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004635
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004636 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4637 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4638 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4639
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004640 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4641 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004642
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004643 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4644 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4645
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004646 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004647
4648
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004649option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004650 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 yes | yes | yes | yes
4653 Arguments :
4654 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4655 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004656 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004657 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004658
4659 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4660 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4661 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4662 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4663 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4664 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4665 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004666 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4667 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4668 possible that the client has already brought one.
4669
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004670 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004671 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004672 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4673 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004674 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4675 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004676
4677 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4678 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4679 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4680 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4681 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4682 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4683 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4684
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004685 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4686 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4687 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4688 are under the control of the end-user.
4689
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004690 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004691 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4692 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004693 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4694 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4695 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004696
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004697 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004698 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4699 frontend www
4700 mode http
4701 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4702
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004703 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4704 backend www
4705 mode http
4706 option forwardfor header X-Client
4707
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004708 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004709 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004710
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004711
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004712option http-buffer-request
4713no option http-buffer-request
4714 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4716 yes | yes | yes | yes
4717 Arguments : none
4718
4719 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4720 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4721 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4722 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4723 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4724 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4725 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4726 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4727 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4728 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4729 default.
4730
4731 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4732
4733
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004734option http-ignore-probes
4735no option http-ignore-probes
4736 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4738 yes | yes | yes | no
4739 Arguments : none
4740
4741 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4742 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4743 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4744 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4745 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4746 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4747 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4748 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4749 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4750 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4751 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4752 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4753
4754 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4755 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4756 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4757 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4758 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4759 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4760 are often the only way to detect them.
4761
4762 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4763 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4764
4765 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4766
4767
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004768option http-keep-alive
4769no option http-keep-alive
4770 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4772 yes | yes | yes | yes
4773 Arguments : none
4774
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004775 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4776 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4777 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4778 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4779 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4780 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4781 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4782
4783 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4784 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004785 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4786 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4787 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4788 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4789 situations where this option may be useful :
4790
4791 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4792 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4793
4794 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4795 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4796
4797 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4798 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4799 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4800 request.
4801
4802 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4803 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004804 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4805 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4806 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004807
4808 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4809 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4810
4811 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4812 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4813 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4814 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4815 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4816 not set.
4817
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004818 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4819 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004820 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004821 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004822
4823 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004824 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4825 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004826
4827
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004828option http-no-delay
4829no option http-no-delay
4830 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4832 yes | yes | yes | yes
4833 Arguments : none
4834
4835 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4836 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4837 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4838 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4839 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4840 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4841 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4842 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4843 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4844 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4845 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4846 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4847 affected.
4848
4849 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4850 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4851 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4852 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4853 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4854 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4855 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4856 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4857 latency environments.
4858
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004859 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4860
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004861
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004862option http-pretend-keepalive
4863no option http-pretend-keepalive
4864 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | yes | yes | yes
4867 Arguments : none
4868
4869 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4870 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4871 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4872 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4873 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4874 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4875 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4876 consider the response complete.
4877
4878 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4879 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4880 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4881 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4882 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4883 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4884
4885 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4886 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4887 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4888 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4889 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4890 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4891 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4892
4893 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4894 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004895 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004896 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4897 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004898
4899 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4900 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4901
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004902 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4903 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004904
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004905
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004906option http-server-close
4907no option http-server-close
4908 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | yes | yes | yes
4911 Arguments : none
4912
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004913 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4914 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4915 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4916 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4917 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4918 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4919 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4920 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4921 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4922 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4923 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4924 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4925 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4926 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4927 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4928 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004929
4930 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4931 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4932 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4933 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004934 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4935 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004936
4937 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4938 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004939 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4940 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004941 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4942 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004943
4944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4946
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004947 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004948 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4949 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004950
4951
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004952option http-tunnel
4953no option http-tunnel
4954 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4956 yes | yes | yes | yes
4957 Arguments : none
4958
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004959 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4960 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4961 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4962 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4963 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4964 "option http-tunnel".
4965
4966 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004967 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004968 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4969 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4970 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4971 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4972 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4973 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4974 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004975
4976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4978
4979 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4980 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4981 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4982
4983
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004984option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004985no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004986 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 yes | yes | yes | no
4989 Arguments : none
4990
4991 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4992 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4993 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4994 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4995 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4996 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4997 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4998
4999 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5000 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5001 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5002 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5003 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5004 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5005 request along its whole life.
5006
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005007 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5008 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5009 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5010 front of an existing proxy.
5011
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005012 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5013
5014 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5015 http-server-close".
5016
5017
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005018option httpchk
5019option httpchk <uri>
5020option httpchk <method> <uri>
5021option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5022 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | no | yes | yes
5025 Arguments :
5026 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5027 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5028 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5029 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5030 ones.
5031
5032 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5033 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5034 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5035
5036 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5037 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5038 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5039 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5040 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5041
5042 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5043 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5044 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5045 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5046 the lack of any response.
5047
5048 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5049
5050 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5051 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5052 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5053
5054 Examples :
5055 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5056 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5057 backend https_relay
5058 mode tcp
5059 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5060 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5061
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005062 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5063 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5064 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005065
5066
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005067option httpclose
5068no option httpclose
5069 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5071 yes | yes | yes | yes
5072 Arguments : none
5073
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005074 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5075 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5076 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5077 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005078 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005079 "option http-tunnel".
5080
5081 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5082 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5083 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5084 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5085 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5086 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5087 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5088 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005089
5090 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005091 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005092 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5093 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5094 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5095 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5096 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005097
5098 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5099 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005100 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5101 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005102 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5103 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005104
5105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5107
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005108 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5109 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005110
5111
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005112option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005113 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005116 Arguments :
5117 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5118 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5119 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5120 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5121 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005122
5123 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5124 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5125 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5126 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5127 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5128 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5129 ports.
5130
5131 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5132
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005133 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5134 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005136 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005137
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005138
5139option http_proxy
5140no option http_proxy
5141 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5143 yes | yes | yes | yes
5144 Arguments : none
5145
5146 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5147 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5148 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5149 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5150 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5151
5152 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5153 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5154 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5155 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005156 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005157 be analyzed.
5158
5159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5161
5162 Example :
5163 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5164 backend direct_forward
5165 option httpclose
5166 option http_proxy
5167
5168 See also : "option httpclose"
5169
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005170
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005171option independent-streams
5172no option independent-streams
5173 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5175 yes | yes | yes | yes
5176 Arguments : none
5177
5178 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5179 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5180 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5181 receive data or not.
5182
5183 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5184 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5185 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5186 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5187 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5188 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5189 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5190 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5191 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5192 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5193 socket buffers.
5194
5195 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5196 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5197 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5198 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5199 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5200
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005201 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005202 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5203 deprecated.
5204
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005205 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005206
5207
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005208option ldap-check
5209 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5211 yes | no | yes | yes
5212 Arguments : none
5213
5214 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5215 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5216 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5217 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5218
5219 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5220 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5221
5222 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5223 configure it.
5224
5225 Example :
5226 option ldap-check
5227
5228 See also : "option httpchk"
5229
5230
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005231option external-check
5232 Use external processes for server health checks
5233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5234 yes | no | yes | yes
5235
5236 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5237 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5238 command".
5239
5240 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5241
5242 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5243
5244
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005245option log-health-checks
5246no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005247 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5249 yes | no | yes | yes
5250 Arguments : none
5251
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005252 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5253 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5254 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005255
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005256 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5257 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5258 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5259 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5260 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5261
5262 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5263 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005264
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005265 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5266 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5267 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005268
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005269
5270option log-separate-errors
5271no option log-separate-errors
5272 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5274 yes | yes | yes | no
5275 Arguments : none
5276
5277 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5278 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5279 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5280 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5281 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5282 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5283 provides very important information.
5284
5285 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5286 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5287 error logs.
5288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005289 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005290 logging.
5291
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005292
5293option logasap
5294no option logasap
5295 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5297 yes | yes | yes | no
5298 Arguments : none
5299
5300 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5301 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5302 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5303 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5304 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5305 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5306 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005307 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005308 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5309 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5310
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005311 Examples :
5312 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5313 mode http
5314 option httplog
5315 option logasap
5316 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5317
5318 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5319 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5320 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5321 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005323 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005324 logging.
5325
5326
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005327option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005328 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5330 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005331 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005332 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5333 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005334 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005335
5336 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5337 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5338 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5339 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5340 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5341 in the MySQL table, like this :
5342
5343 USE mysql;
5344 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5345 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5346
5347 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5348 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5349 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5350 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5351 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5352 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5353 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5354 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5355 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5356
5357 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5358 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005359
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005360 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005361
5362 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5363 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5364 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5365 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5366 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5367 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5368
5369 See also: "option httpchk"
5370
5371
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005372option nolinger
5373no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005374 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5376 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005377 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005378
5379 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5380 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5381 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5382 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5383 connections.
5384
5385 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5386 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5387 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5388 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5389 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5390 this too.
5391
5392 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5393 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5394 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5395
5396 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5397 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5398 for servers.
5399
5400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5402
5403
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005404option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5405 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5407 yes | yes | yes | yes
5408 Arguments :
5409 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5410 matching <network>
5411 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5412 header name.
5413
5414 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5415 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5416 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5417 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5418 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5419 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5420 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5421 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5422 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5423 possible that the client has already brought one.
5424
5425 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5426 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5427 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5428 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5429 header and requires different one.
5430
5431 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5432 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5433 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5434 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5435 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5436 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5437 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5438
5439 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5440 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5441 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5442 both are defined.
5443
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005444 Examples :
5445 # Original Destination address
5446 frontend www
5447 mode http
5448 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5449
5450 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5451 backend www
5452 mode http
5453 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5454
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005455 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5456 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005457
5458
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005459option persist
5460no option persist
5461 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005464 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005465
5466 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5467 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5468 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5469 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5470 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5471 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5472 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5473 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5474 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5475 redirected to another valid server.
5476
5477 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5478 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5479
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005480 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005481
5482
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005483option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5484 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5486 yes | no | yes | yes
5487 Arguments :
5488 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5489 PostgreSQL server.
5490
5491 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5492 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5493 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5494 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5495
5496 See also: "option httpchk"
5497
5498
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005499option prefer-last-server
5500no option prefer-last-server
5501 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5503 yes | no | yes | yes
5504 Arguments : none
5505
5506 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5507 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5508 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5509 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5510 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5511 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5512 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5513 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5514 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005515 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5516 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5517 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5518 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5519 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5520 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5521 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005522
5523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5525
5526 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5527
5528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005529option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005530option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005531no option redispatch
5532 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5533 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5534 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005535 Arguments :
5536 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5537 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5538 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5539 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5540 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5541 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5542 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5543 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5544 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005546
5547 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5548 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5549 be able to access the service anymore.
5550
5551 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5552 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5553
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005554 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005555 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5556 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005558 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5559 "redisp" keywords.
5560
5561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5563
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005564 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005565
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005566
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005567option redis-check
5568 Use redis health checks for server testing
5569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5570 yes | no | yes | yes
5571 Arguments : none
5572
5573 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5574 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5575 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5576 find the "+PONG" response message.
5577
5578 Example :
5579 option redis-check
5580
5581 See also : "option httpchk"
5582
5583
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005584option smtpchk
5585option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5586 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5588 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005589 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005590 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5591 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5592 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5593
5594 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5595 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5596 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5597
5598 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5599 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5600 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5601 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5602 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5603 dead server.
5604
5605 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5606 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5607 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5608 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5609
5610 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5611 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5612 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5613 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5614 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5615
5616 Example :
5617 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5618
5619 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005622option socket-stats
5623no option socket-stats
5624
5625 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | yes | yes | no
5628
5629 Arguments : none
5630
5631
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005632option splice-auto
5633no option splice-auto
5634 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5636 yes | yes | yes | yes
5637 Arguments : none
5638
5639 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5640 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5641 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5642 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005643 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005644 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5645 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5646 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5647 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5648
5649 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5650 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5651 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5652 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5653 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5654 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5655 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5656 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5657 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5658 keyword.
5659
5660 Example :
5661 option splice-auto
5662
5663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5665
5666 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5667 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5668
5669
5670option splice-request
5671no option splice-request
5672 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5674 yes | yes | yes | yes
5675 Arguments : none
5676
5677 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005678 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005679 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5680 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5681 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5682 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5683
5684 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5685
5686 Example :
5687 option splice-request
5688
5689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5691
5692 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5693 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5694
5695
5696option splice-response
5697no option splice-response
5698 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 yes | yes | yes | yes
5701 Arguments : none
5702
5703 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005704 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005705 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5706 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5707 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5708 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5709
5710 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5711
5712 Example :
5713 option splice-response
5714
5715 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5716 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5717
5718 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5719 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5720
5721
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005722option srvtcpka
5723no option srvtcpka
5724 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | no | yes | yes
5727 Arguments : none
5728
5729 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5730 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5731 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5732 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5733
5734 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5735 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5736 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5737 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5738
5739 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5740 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5741 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5742 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5743 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5744
5745 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5746
5747 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5748 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5749 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5750
5751 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5752 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5753
5754 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5755
5756
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005757option ssl-hello-chk
5758 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 yes | no | yes | yes
5761 Arguments : none
5762
5763 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5764 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5765 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5766 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5767 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5768 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5769 hello message.
5770
5771 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5772 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5773 messages, which is appreciable.
5774
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005775 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5776 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5777 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005778
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005779 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5780
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005781
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005782option tcp-check
5783 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5785 yes | no | yes | yes
5786
5787 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5788 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5789
5790 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5791 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5792 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5793
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005794 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005795 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5796 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5797 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5798 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5799 only.
5800
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005801 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005802 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5803 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5804 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5805 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5806
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005807 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005808 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5809 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005810 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005811 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5812 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5813 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5814 the respective protocols.
5815 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5816 analysed.
5817
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005818 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5819 script.
5820
5821 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5822 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5823 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5824 The "comment" is of course optional.
5825
5826
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005827 Examples :
5828 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5829 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005830 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005831
5832 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5833 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005834 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005835
5836 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5837 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005838 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005839 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005840 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005841 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005842 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5843 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005844 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5845 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005846 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005847 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5848 tcp-check expect string +OK
5849
5850 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5851 (send many headers before analyzing)
5852 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005853 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005854 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5855 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5856 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5857 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005858 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005859
5860
5861 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5862
5863
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005864option tcp-smart-accept
5865no option tcp-smart-accept
5866 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 yes | yes | yes | no
5869 Arguments : none
5870
5871 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5872 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5873 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5874 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5875 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5876 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5877
5878 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5879 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5880 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5881 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5882
5883 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5884 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5885 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5886 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5887
5888 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5889 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5890 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5891
5892 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5893 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5894 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5895
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005896 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5897
5898
5899option tcp-smart-connect
5900no option tcp-smart-connect
5901 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 yes | no | yes | yes
5904 Arguments : none
5905
5906 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5907 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5908 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5909 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5910 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5911
5912 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5913 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5914 complex.
5915
5916 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5917 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5918 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5919
5920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5922
5923 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5924
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005925
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005926option tcpka
5927 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5929 yes | yes | yes | yes
5930 Arguments : none
5931
5932 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5933 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5934 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5935 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5936
5937 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5938 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5939 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5940 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5941
5942 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5943 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5944 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5945 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5946 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5947
5948 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5949
5950 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5951 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5952 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5953 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5954 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5955 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5956 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5957 backends.
5958
5959 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5960
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005961
5962option tcplog
5963 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 yes | yes | yes | yes
5966 Arguments : none
5967
5968 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5969 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5970 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5971 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5972 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5973 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5974 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5975 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5976
5977 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005979 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005980
5981
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005982option transparent
5983no option transparent
5984 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005986 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005987 Arguments : none
5988
5989 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5990 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5991 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5992 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5993 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5994 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5995 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5996 appropriate server.
5997
5998 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5999 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6000
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006001 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006002 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006003
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006004
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006005external-check command <command>
6006 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | no | yes | yes
6009
6010 Arguments :
6011 <command> is the external command to run
6012
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006013 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6014
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006015 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006016
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006017 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6018 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6019 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6020 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6021 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6022 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006023
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006024 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6025
6026 Environment variables :
6027 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6028 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6029
6030 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6031
6032 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6033
6034 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6035 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6036 for a UNIX socket).
6037
6038 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6039
6040 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6041
6042 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6043
6044 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6045
6046 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6047
6048 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6049 socket).
6050
6051 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6052 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6053
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006054 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6055 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6056 failed.
6057
6058 Example :
6059 external-check command /bin/true
6060
6061 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6062
6063
6064external-check path <path>
6065 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6067 yes | no | yes | yes
6068
6069 Arguments :
6070 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6071
6072 The default path is "".
6073
6074 Example :
6075 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6076
6077 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6078 "external-check command"
6079
6080
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006081persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006082persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006083 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6085 yes | no | yes | yes
6086 Arguments :
6087 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006088 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6089 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006090
6091 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6092 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6093 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6094 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6095 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6096 forwarded to this server.
6097
6098 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6099 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6100 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006101 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006102 a single "listen" section.
6103
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006104 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6105 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6106 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6107
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006108 Example :
6109 listen tse-farm
6110 bind :3389
6111 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6112 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6113 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6114 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6115 persist rdp-cookie
6116 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006117 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006118 balance rdp-cookie
6119 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6120 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6121
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006122 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6123 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006124
6125
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006126rate-limit sessions <rate>
6127 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6129 yes | yes | yes | no
6130 Arguments :
6131 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6132 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6133
6134 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6135 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6136 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6137 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6138 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6139 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6140
6141 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6142 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6143 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6144 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6145
6146 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6147 listen smtp
6148 mode tcp
6149 bind :25
6150 rate-limit sessions 10
6151 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6152
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006153 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6154 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6155 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006156
6157 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6158
6159
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006160redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6161redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6162redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006163 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 no | yes | yes | yes
6166
6167 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006168 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006169
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006170 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006171 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006172 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6173 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6174 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006175
6176 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6177 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6178 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6179 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6180 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006181 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6182 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6183 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6184 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006185
6186 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6187 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6188 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6189 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6190 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6191 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006192 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006193 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006194 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6195 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6196 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006197
6198 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006199 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6200 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6201 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6202 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6203 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6204 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6205 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6206 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006207
6208 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6209 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6210
6211 - "drop-query"
6212 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6213 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6214 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6215 with a location-type redirect.
6216
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006217 - "append-slash"
6218 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6219 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6220 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6221 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6222
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006223 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6224 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6225 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6226 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6227 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6228 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6229 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6230
6231 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6232 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6233 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6234 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6235 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6236 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6237 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006238
6239 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6240 acl clear dst_port 80
6241 acl secure dst_port 8080
6242 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006243 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006244 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006245 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6246
6247 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006248 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6249 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6250 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006251 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006252
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006253 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6254 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6255 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6256
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006257 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006258 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006259
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006260 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6261 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6262 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006264 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006265
6266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006267redisp (deprecated)
6268redispatch (deprecated)
6269 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6271 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006272 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006273
6274 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6275 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6276 be able to access the service anymore.
6277
6278 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6279 redistribute them to a working server.
6280
6281 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6282 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6283 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006285 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6286 "option redispatch" instead.
6287
6288 See also : "option redispatch"
6289
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006290
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006291reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006292 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6294 no | yes | yes | yes
6295 Arguments :
6296 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6297 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006298 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006299
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006300 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6301 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6302
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006303 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6304 the last header of an HTTP request.
6305
6306 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6307 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6308 responses.
6309
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006310 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6311 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6312 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6313
6314 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6315 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006316
6317
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006318reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6319reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006320 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6322 no | yes | yes | yes
6323 Arguments :
6324 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6325 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6326 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6327 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6328 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6329 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6330 ignores case.
6331
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006332 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6333 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6334
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006335 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6336 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6337 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6338 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006339 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006340
6341 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6342 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6343
6344 Example :
6345 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6346 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6347 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6348
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006349 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6350 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006351
6352
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006353reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6354reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006355 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6357 no | yes | yes | yes
6358 Arguments :
6359 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6360 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6361 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6362 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6363 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6364 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6365
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006366 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6367 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6368
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006369 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6370 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6371 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6372 next servers.
6373
6374 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6375 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6376 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6377
6378 Example :
6379 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6380 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6381 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6382
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006383 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6384 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006385
6386
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006387reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6388reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006389 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6391 no | yes | yes | yes
6392 Arguments :
6393 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6394 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6395 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6396 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6397 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6398 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6399 case.
6400
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006401 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6402 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6403
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006404 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6405 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6406 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6407 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006408 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006409
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006410 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006411 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006412 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006413
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006414 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6415 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6416
6417 Example :
6418 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6419 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6420 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6421
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006422 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6423 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006424
6425
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006426reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6427reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006428 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 no | yes | yes | yes
6431 Arguments :
6432 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6433 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6434 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6435 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6436 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6437 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6438 case.
6439
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006440 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6441 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6442
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006443 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6444 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6445 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6446 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6447
6448 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6449 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6450
6451 Example :
6452 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6453 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6454 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6455 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6456
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006457 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6458 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006459
6460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006461reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6462reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006463 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6465 no | yes | yes | yes
6466 Arguments :
6467 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6468 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6469 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6470 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6471 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6472 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6473
6474 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6475 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6476 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6477 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006478 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006479
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006480 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6481 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6482
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006483 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6484 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6485 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6486
6487 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6488 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6489 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6490 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6491 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6492
6493 Example :
6494 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006495 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006496 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6497 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6498
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006499 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6500 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006501
6502
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006503reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6504reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006505 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 no | yes | yes | yes
6508 Arguments :
6509 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6510 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6511 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6512 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6513 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6514 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6515 ignores case.
6516
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006517 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6518 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6519
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006520 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6521 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006522 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6523 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6524 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006525 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6526 not set.
6527
6528 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6529 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6530 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6531 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6532 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6533
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006534 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006535 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6536 # block all others.
6537 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6538 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6539
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006540 # block bad guys
6541 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6542 reqitarpit . if badguys
6543
6544 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6545 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006546
6547
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006548retries <value>
6549 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | no | yes | yes
6552 Arguments :
6553 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6554 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6555 default value is 3.
6556
6557 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6558 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6559 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6560
6561 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006562 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6563 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006564
6565 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6566 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6567
6568 See also : "option redispatch"
6569
6570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006571rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006572 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 no | yes | yes | yes
6575 Arguments :
6576 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6577 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006578 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006579
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006580 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6581 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6582
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006583 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6584 the last header of an HTTP response.
6585
6586 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6587 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6588 responses.
6589
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006590 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6591 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006592
6593
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006594rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6595rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006596 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 no | yes | yes | yes
6599 Arguments :
6600 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6601 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6602 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6603 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6604 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6605 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6606 ignores case.
6607
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006608 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6609 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6610
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006611 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6612 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006613 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006614 client.
6615
6616 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6617 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6618 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6619
6620 Example :
6621 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006622 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006623
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006624 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6625 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006626
6627
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006628rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6629rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006630 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6632 no | yes | yes | yes
6633 Arguments :
6634 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6635 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6636 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6637 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6638 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6639 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6640 ignores case.
6641
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006642 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6643 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6644
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006645 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6646 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6647 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6648 case-sensitive.
6649
6650 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006651 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6652 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6653 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006654
6655 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6656 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6657
6658 Example :
6659 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6660 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6661
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006662 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6663 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006664
6665
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006666rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6667rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006668 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6670 no | yes | yes | yes
6671 Arguments :
6672 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6673 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6674 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6675 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6676 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6677 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6678 ignores case.
6679
6680 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6681 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6682 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6683 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006684 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006685
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006686 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6687 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6688
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006689 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6690 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6691 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6692
6693 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6694 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6695 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6696 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6697 are not case-sensitive.
6698
6699 Example :
6700 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6701 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6702
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006703 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6704 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006705
6706
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006707server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006708 Declare a server in a backend
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 no | no | yes | yes
6711 Arguments :
6712 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006713 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006714 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006715
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006716 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6717 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6718 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6719 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006720 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6721 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6722 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6723 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6724 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006725 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6726 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6727 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6728 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6729 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6730 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6731 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006732 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006733 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6734 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6735 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006736
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006737 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006738 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6739 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6740 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6741 adding this value to the client's port.
6742
6743 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6744 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006745 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006746
6747 Examples :
6748 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6749 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006750 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006751 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6752 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6753 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006754
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006755 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6756 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006757
6758
6759source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006760source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006761source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006762 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6764 yes | no | yes | yes
6765 Arguments :
6766 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6767 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006768
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006769 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006770 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6771 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6772 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6773 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6774 supported prefixes are :
6775 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6776 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6777 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006778 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006779 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6780 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006781
6782 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6783 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006784 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6785 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6786 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006787
6788 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6789 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6790 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6791 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6792 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6793 <addr>.
6794
6795 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6796 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6797 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6798 port.
6799
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006800 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6801 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6802 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6803 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006804 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006805 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6806 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6807 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6808 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6809 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6810 HTTP header.
6811
6812 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6813 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006814 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006815 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6816 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6817 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6818 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6819 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6820 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6821 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6822
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006823 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6824 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6825 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6826 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6827 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6828 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6829
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006830 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6831 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6832 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6833 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6834
6835 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6836 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6837 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6838 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6839 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6840 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6841
6842 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6843 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6844 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6845 there are two methods :
6846
6847 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6848 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6849 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6850 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6851 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6852 of the client ranges may be used.
6853
6854 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6855 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6856 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6857 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6858 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6859 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6860 same session.
6861
6862 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6863 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6864 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6865 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6866 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6867 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6868
6869 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6870 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6871 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006872 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006873
6874 Examples :
6875 backend private
6876 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6877 source 192.168.1.200
6878
6879 backend transparent_ssl1
6880 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6881 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6882
6883 backend transparent_ssl2
6884 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6885 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6886 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6887
6888 backend transparent_ssl3
6889 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6890 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6891 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6892
6893 backend transparent_smtp
6894 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6895 # with Tproxy version 4.
6896 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6897
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006898 backend transparent_http
6899 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6900 # proxy.
6901 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006904 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006906
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006907srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6908 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6910 yes | no | yes | yes
6911 Arguments :
6912 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6913 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6914 as explained at the top of this document.
6915
6916 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6917 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6918 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6919 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6920 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6921 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6922 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6923
6924 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6925 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6926 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6927 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6928 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006929 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006930 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006931 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006932
6933 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6934 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6935 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6936 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6937 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6938 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6939
6940 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6941 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6942
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006943 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6944 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006945
6946
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006947stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6948 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006950 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006951
6952 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6953 matched.
6954
6955 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6956 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6957
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006958 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6959 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6960 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6961
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006962 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6963 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6964 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6965 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006966
6967 Example :
6968 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6969 backend stats_localhost
6970 stats enable
6971 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6972
6973 Example :
6974 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6975 backend stats_auth
6976 stats enable
6977 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6978 stats admin if TRUE
6979
6980 Example :
6981 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6982 userlist stats-auth
6983 group admin users admin
6984 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6985 group readonly users haproxy
6986 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6987
6988 backend stats_auth
6989 stats enable
6990 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6991 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6992 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6993 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6994
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006995 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6996 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6997 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006998
6999
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007000stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7001 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007003 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007004 Arguments :
7005 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7006
7007 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7008
7009 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7010 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7011 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7012 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7013 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7014 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7015
7016 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7017 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7018 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007019 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007020
7021 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7022 report using "stats scope".
7023
7024 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7025 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7026 unobvious parameters.
7027
7028 Example :
7029 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7030 backend public_www
7031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7032 stats enable
7033 stats hide-version
7034 stats scope .
7035 stats uri /admin?stats
7036 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7037 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7038 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7039
7040 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7041 backend private_monitoring
7042 stats enable
7043 stats uri /admin?stats
7044 stats refresh 5s
7045
7046 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7047
7048
7049stats enable
7050 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007052 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007053 Arguments : none
7054
7055 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7056 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7057 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7058 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7059 - stats auth : no authentication
7060 - stats scope : no restriction
7061
7062 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7063 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7064 unobvious parameters.
7065
7066 Example :
7067 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7068 backend public_www
7069 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7070 stats enable
7071 stats hide-version
7072 stats scope .
7073 stats uri /admin?stats
7074 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7075 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7076 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7077
7078 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7079 backend private_monitoring
7080 stats enable
7081 stats uri /admin?stats
7082 stats refresh 5s
7083
7084 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7085
7086
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007087stats hide-version
7088 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007090 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007091 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007092
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007093 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7094 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7095 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7096 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7097 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7098 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007100 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7101 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7102 unobvious parameters.
7103
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007104 Example :
7105 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7106 backend public_www
7107 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007108 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007109 stats hide-version
7110 stats scope .
7111 stats uri /admin?stats
7112 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7113 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7114 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007115
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007116 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7117 backend private_monitoring
7118 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007119 stats uri /admin?stats
7120 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007121
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007122 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007123
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007124
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007125stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7126 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7127 Access control for statistics
7128
7129 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7130 no | no | yes | yes
7131
7132 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7133 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7134 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7135 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7136 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7137 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7138
7139 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7140 instance.
7141
7142 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7143 about ACL usage.
7144
7145
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007146stats realm <realm>
7147 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007149 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007150 Arguments :
7151 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7152 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7153 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7154
7155 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7156 using a backslash ('\').
7157
7158 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7159 only related to authentication.
7160
7161 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7162 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7163 unobvious parameters.
7164
7165 Example :
7166 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7167 backend public_www
7168 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7169 stats enable
7170 stats hide-version
7171 stats scope .
7172 stats uri /admin?stats
7173 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7174 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7175 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7176
7177 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7178 backend private_monitoring
7179 stats enable
7180 stats uri /admin?stats
7181 stats refresh 5s
7182
7183 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7184
7185
7186stats refresh <delay>
7187 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007189 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007190 Arguments :
7191 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7192 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7193 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7194 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7195 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7196 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7197
7198 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7199 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7200 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7201 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7202
7203 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7204 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7205 unobvious parameters.
7206
7207 Example :
7208 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7209 backend public_www
7210 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7211 stats enable
7212 stats hide-version
7213 stats scope .
7214 stats uri /admin?stats
7215 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7216 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7217 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7218
7219 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7220 backend private_monitoring
7221 stats enable
7222 stats uri /admin?stats
7223 stats refresh 5s
7224
7225 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7226
7227
7228stats scope { <name> | "." }
7229 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007231 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007232 Arguments :
7233 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7234 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7235 section in which the statement appears.
7236
7237 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7238 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7239 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7240 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7241 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7242 exists.
7243
7244 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7245 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7246 unobvious parameters.
7247
7248 Example :
7249 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7250 backend public_www
7251 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7252 stats enable
7253 stats hide-version
7254 stats scope .
7255 stats uri /admin?stats
7256 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7257 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7258 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7259
7260 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7261 backend private_monitoring
7262 stats enable
7263 stats uri /admin?stats
7264 stats refresh 5s
7265
7266 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7267
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007268
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007269stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007270 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007272 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007273
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007274 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007275 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7276
7277 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7278 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7279
7280 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7281 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007282 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007283
7284 Example :
7285 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7286 backend private_monitoring
7287 stats enable
7288 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7289 stats uri /admin?stats
7290 stats refresh 5s
7291
7292 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7293 global section.
7294
7295
7296stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007297 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 yes | yes | yes | yes
7300 Arguments : none
7301
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007302 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007303 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7304 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7305 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7306 - IP (socket, server)
7307 - cookie (backend, server)
7308
7309 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7310 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007311 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007312
7313 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7314
7315
7316stats show-node [ <name> ]
7317 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007319 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007320 Arguments:
7321 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7322 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7323
7324 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7325 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007326 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007327
7328 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7329 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7330 unobvious parameters.
7331
7332 Example:
7333 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7334 backend private_monitoring
7335 stats enable
7336 stats show-node Europe-1
7337 stats uri /admin?stats
7338 stats refresh 5s
7339
7340 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7341 section.
7342
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007343
7344stats uri <prefix>
7345 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007347 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007348 Arguments :
7349 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7350 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7351 query string.
7352
7353 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7354 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7355 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7356 possible to reach it in the application.
7357
7358 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007359 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007360 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7361 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7362 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7363 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7364
7365 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7366 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7367 an address or a port to statistics only.
7368
7369 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7370 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7371 unobvious parameters.
7372
7373 Example :
7374 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7375 backend public_www
7376 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7377 stats enable
7378 stats hide-version
7379 stats scope .
7380 stats uri /admin?stats
7381 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7382 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7383 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7384
7385 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7386 backend private_monitoring
7387 stats enable
7388 stats uri /admin?stats
7389 stats refresh 5s
7390
7391 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7392
7393
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007394stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7395 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007397 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007398
7399 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007400 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007401 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7402 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7403 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7404
7405 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7406 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7407 the "stick-table" statement.
7408
7409 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7410 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7411 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7412 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7413 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7414
7415 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7416 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7417 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7418 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7419 transformation rules.
7420
7421 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7422 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7423 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7424 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7425 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7426 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7427 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7428
7429 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7430 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7431 ACL based conditions.
7432
7433 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7434 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7435 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7436 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7437
7438 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7439 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7440 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7441 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7442
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007443 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7444 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7445 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7446
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007447 Example :
7448 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7449 # last 30 minutes
7450 backend pop
7451 mode tcp
7452 balance roundrobin
7453 stick store-request src
7454 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7455 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7456 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7457
7458 backend smtp
7459 mode tcp
7460 balance roundrobin
7461 stick match src table pop
7462 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7463 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7464
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007465 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007466 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007467
7468
7469stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7470 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7472 no | no | yes | yes
7473
7474 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7475 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7476 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7477 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7478
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007479 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7480 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7481 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7482
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007483 Examples :
7484 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007485 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007486
7487 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7488 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7489 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7490
7491
7492 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7493 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7494 backend http
7495 mode http
7496 balance roundrobin
7497 stick on src table https
7498 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7499 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7500 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7501
7502 backend https
7503 mode tcp
7504 balance roundrobin
7505 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7506 stick on src
7507 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7508 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7509
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007510 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007511
7512
7513stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7514 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7516 no | no | yes | yes
7517
7518 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007519 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007520 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7521 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7522 server is selected.
7523
7524 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7525 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7526 the "stick-table" statement.
7527
7528 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7529 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7530 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7531 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7532 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7533 address.
7534
7535 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7536 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7537 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7538 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7539 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7540 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7541 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7542 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7543 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7544 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7545
7546 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7547 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7548 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7549 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7550 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7551 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7552 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7553
7554 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7555 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7556 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7557 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7558
7559 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7560 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7561 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7562 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7563 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7564 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007565 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7566 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7567 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7568 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7569 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7570 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007571
7572 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7573 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7574 the request.
7575
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007576 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7577 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7578 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7579
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007580 Example :
7581 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7582 # last 30 minutes
7583 backend pop
7584 mode tcp
7585 balance roundrobin
7586 stick store-request src
7587 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7588 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7589 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7590
7591 backend smtp
7592 mode tcp
7593 balance roundrobin
7594 stick match src table pop
7595 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7596 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7597
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007598 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007599 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007600
7601
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007602stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007603 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7604 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007605 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007607 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007608
7609 Arguments :
7610 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7611 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7612 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7613 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7614
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007615 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7616 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7617 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7618 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7619
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007620 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7621 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7622 instance.
7623
7624 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7625 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7626 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7627 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7628 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7629 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007630 to 32 characters.
7631
7632 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7633 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7634 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007635 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007636 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7637 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007638
7639 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007640 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7641 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007642 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7643 increase.
7644
7645 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007646 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7647 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7648 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007649
7650 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7651 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7652 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7653 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7654 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7655 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7656 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7657 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7658 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7659 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7660 parameter (see below).
7661
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007662 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7663 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7664 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7665 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7666 soft restart.
7667
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007668 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7669 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007670
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007671 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7672 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7673 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7674 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7675 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007676 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007677 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7678 if not expiration delay is specified.
7679
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007680 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7681 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7682 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7683 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007684 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7685 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7686 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7687 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7688 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7689 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7690 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7691 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7692 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7693 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7694 types and their arguments.
7695
7696 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7697 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7698 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7699 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7700
7701 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7702 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7703 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7704 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7705
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007706 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7707 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7708 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7709 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7710 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7711 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7712
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007713 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7714 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7715 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7716 they were received.
7717
7718 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7719 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7720 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7721 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7722 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7723
7724 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7725 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7726 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7727 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7728 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7729
7730 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7731 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7732 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7733
7734 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7735 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7736 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7737 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7738 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7739
7740 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7741 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7742 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7743 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7744 the client side.
7745
7746 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7747 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7748 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7749 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7750 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7751 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7752 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7753
7754 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7755 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7756 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7757 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7758 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7759 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7760 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7761
7762 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7763 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7764 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7765 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7766 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7767 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7768
7769 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7770 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7771 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7772 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7773
7774 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7775 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7776 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7777 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7778 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7779 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7780 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7781 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7782 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7783 recommended for better fairness.
7784
7785 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7786 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7787 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7788 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7789
7790 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7791 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7792 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7793 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7794 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7795 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7796 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7797 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7798 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7799 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007800
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007801 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7802 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007803 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7804 reference it.
7805
7806 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7807 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7808 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7809 as an exclusive stickiness.
7810
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007811 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7812 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7813 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7814 something that can be ignored.
7815
7816 Example:
7817 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7818 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7819 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7820 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7821
7822 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007823 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007824
7825
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007826stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7827 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 no | no | yes | yes
7830
7831 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007832 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007833 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7834 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7835 server is selected.
7836
7837 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7838 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7839 the "stick-table" statement.
7840
7841 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7842 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7843 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7844 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7845
7846 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7847 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7848 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7849 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7850 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7851 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007852 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007853 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7854 rules.
7855
7856 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7857 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7858 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7859 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7860 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7861 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7862 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7863
7864 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7865 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7866 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7867 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7868
7869 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7870 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7871 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7872 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7873 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7874 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007875 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7876 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7877 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7878 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7879 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7880 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7881 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7882 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7883 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007884
7885 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7886
7887 Example :
7888 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7889 backend https
7890 mode tcp
7891 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007892 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007893 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007894
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007895 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7896 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7897
7898 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7899 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7900 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7901
7902 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7903 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007904
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007905 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7906 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7907 # at offset 44.
7908
7909 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7910 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7911
7912 # Learn on response if server hello.
7913 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007914
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007915 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7916 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7917
7918 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7919 extraction.
7920
7921
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007922tcp-check connect [params*]
7923 Opens a new connection
7924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7925 no | no | yes | yes
7926
7927 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7928 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7929 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7930
7931 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7932 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7933 of the sequence.
7934
7935 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7936 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7937 do.
7938
7939 Parameters :
7940 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7941 use the TCP connection.
7942
7943 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7944 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7945 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7946
7947 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7948
7949 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7950
7951 Examples:
7952 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7953 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7954 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7955 option tcp-check
7956 tcp-check connect
7957 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7958 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7959 tcp-check send \r\n
7960 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7961 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7962 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7963 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7964 tcp-check send \r\n
7965 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7966 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7967
7968 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7969 option tcp-check
7970 tcp-check connect port 110
7971 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7972 tcp-check connect port 143
7973 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7974 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7975
7976 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7977
7978
7979tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7980 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 no | no | yes | yes
7983
7984 Arguments :
7985 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7986 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7987 binary.
7988 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7989 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7990 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7991
7992 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7993 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7994 with the usual backslash ('\').
7995 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7996 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7997 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7998 used upper or lower case.
7999
8000
8001 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8002
8003 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8004 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8005 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8006 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8007 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8008 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8009 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8010 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8011
8012 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8013 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8014 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8015 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8016 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8017 expression.
8018
8019 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8020 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8021 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8022 this exact hexadecimal string.
8023 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8024
8025 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8026 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8027 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8028 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8029 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8030 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8031 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8032 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8033 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8034 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8035 the null character.
8036
8037 Examples :
8038 # perform a POP check
8039 option tcp-check
8040 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8041
8042 # perform an IMAP check
8043 option tcp-check
8044 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8045
8046 # look for the redis master server
8047 option tcp-check
8048 tcp-check send PING\r\n
8049 tcp-check expect +PONG
8050 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8051 tcp-check expect string role:master
8052 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8053 tcp-check expect string +OK
8054
8055
8056 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8057 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8058
8059
8060tcp-check send <data>
8061 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 no | no | yes | yes
8064
8065 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8066 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8067
8068 Examples :
8069 # look for the redis master server
8070 option tcp-check
8071 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8072 tcp-check expect string role:master
8073
8074 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8075 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8076
8077
8078tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8079 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8080 tcp health check
8081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8082 no | no | yes | yes
8083
8084 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8085 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8086 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8087 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8088 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8089 hexadecimal string.
8090 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8091
8092 Examples :
8093 # redis check in binary
8094 option tcp-check
8095 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8096 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8097
8098
8099 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8100 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8101
8102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008103tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8104 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8106 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008107 Arguments :
8108 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008109 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8110 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008112 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008113
8114 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8115 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008116 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8117 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8118 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8119 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8120 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8121 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008123 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8124 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8125 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8126 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008127
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008128 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008129 - accept :
8130 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8131 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8132 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008134 - reject :
8135 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8136 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8137 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8138 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8139 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8140 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8141 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8142 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8143 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8144 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8145 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8146 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008147
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008148 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8149 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8150 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8151 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8152 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8153 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8154 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8155 hosts.
8156
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008157 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8158 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8159 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8160 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8161 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8162 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8163 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8164 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8165 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008166 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8167 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008168
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008169 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008170 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008171 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008172 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008173 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8174 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008175 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008176 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8177 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8178 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8179 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8180 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008182 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008183 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008184 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008185 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8186 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8187 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8188 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008190 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8191 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8192 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8193 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008195 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8196 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8197 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8198 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8199 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008200 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8201 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8202 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8203 layer7 information is extracted.
8204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008205 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8206 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8207 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8208 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8209 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008211 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8212 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8213 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008215 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8216 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8217 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008219 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008220 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008221 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008223 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8224 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8225 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008227 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008228 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8229 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008230
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008231 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8232
8233 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8234
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008235 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008237 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008238
8239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008240tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8241 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008243 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008244 Arguments :
8245 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008246 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008247 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8248 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008250 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008252 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8253 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8254 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8255 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8256 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008258 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8259 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8260 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8261 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008262 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8263 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8264 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8265 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8266 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8267 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008268 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008269 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008271 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8272 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8273 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8274 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008275
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008276 Four types of actions are supported :
8277 - accept : the request is accepted
8278 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8279 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008280 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008281 - lua <function>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008282 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008284 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8285 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008286
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008287 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8288 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8289 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8290 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8291 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8292 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008294 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008295 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8296 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008298 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008299 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8300 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8301 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8302 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008303 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8304 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8305 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008306
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008307 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008308 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8309 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8310 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008311
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008312 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8313 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8314 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8315 documentation.
8316
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008317 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8318 declared inline.
8319
8320 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8321 The allowed scopes are:
8322 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8323 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8324 (request and response)
8325 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8326 processing
8327 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8328 processing.
8329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8330 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8331
8332 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8333 followed by some converters.
8334
8335 Example:
8336
8337 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8338
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008339 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008340 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8341 # and reject everything else.
8342 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8343 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008344 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008345 tcp-request content reject
8346
8347 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008348 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8349 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8350 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008351 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008352
8353 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8354 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8355 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008356 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008357 tcp-request content reject
8358
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008359 Example:
8360 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8361 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008362 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008363
8364 Example:
8365 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8366 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008367 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008369 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8370 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8371
8372 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008373 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008374 # protecting all our sites
8375 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008376 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8377 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008378 ...
8379 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8380
8381 backend http_dynamic
8382 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008383 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008384 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008385 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8386 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8387 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008388 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008390 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008391
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008392 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008393
8394
8395tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8396 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008398 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008399 Arguments :
8400 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8401 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8402 as explained at the top of this document.
8403
8404 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8405 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8406 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8407 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8408 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8409
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008410 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8411 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8412 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8413 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8414
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008415 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8416 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008417 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008418 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008419 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8420 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8421 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8422 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008423
8424 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8425 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8426 it pass through unaffected.
8427
8428 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8429 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8430 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008431 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008432 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8433 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008434 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8435 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8436 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008437
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008438 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008439 "timeout client".
8440
8441
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008442tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8443 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8445 no | no | yes | yes
8446 Arguments :
8447 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008448 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008449
8450 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8451
8452 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8453 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8454 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008455 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8456 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008457
8458 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8459
8460 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8461 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8462 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8463 inserted.
8464
8465 Two types of actions are supported :
8466 - accept :
8467 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8468 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8469 the rules evaluation.
8470
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008471 - close :
8472 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8473 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8474 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8475 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8476 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8477 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008478 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008479 protocols.
8480
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008481 - reject :
8482 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8483 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008484 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008485
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008486 - lua <function>
8487 Executes Lua.
8488
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008489 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8490 Sets a variable.
8491
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008492 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8493 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8494 for changing the default action to a reject.
8495
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008496 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8497 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8498 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8499 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008500 period.
8501
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008502 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8503 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8504 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8505 documentation.
8506
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008507 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8508 declared inline.
8509
8510 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8511 The allowed scopes are:
8512 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8513 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8514 (request and response)
8515 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8516 processing
8517 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8518 processing.
8519 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8520 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8521
8522 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8523 followed by some converters.
8524
8525 Example:
8526
8527 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8528
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008529 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8530
8531 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8532
8533
8534tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8535 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8537 no | no | yes | yes
8538 Arguments :
8539 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8540 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8541 as explained at the top of this document.
8542
8543 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8544
8545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008546timeout check <timeout>
8547 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8548 established.
8549
8550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | no | yes | yes
8552 Arguments:
8553 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8554 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8555 as explained at the top of this document.
8556
8557 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8558 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8559 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8560 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008561 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8562 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8563 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008564
8565 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8566 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8567
8568 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8569 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008570 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008571
8572 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8573 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8574 forget about it.
8575
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008576 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8577 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008578
8579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008580timeout client <timeout>
8581timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8582 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8584 yes | yes | yes | no
8585 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008586 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008587 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8588 as explained at the top of this document.
8589
8590 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8591 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8592 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8593 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8594 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8595 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8596 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8597 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008598 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008599 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008600 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8601 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008602 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8603 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008604
8605 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8606 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8607 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8608 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8609 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8610 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8611
8612 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8613 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8614 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8615
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008616 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008617
8618
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008619timeout client-fin <timeout>
8620 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8622 yes | yes | yes | no
8623 Arguments :
8624 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8626 as explained at the top of this document.
8627
8628 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8629 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8630 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8631 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8632 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8633 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8634 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8635 down in one direction.
8636
8637 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8638 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8639 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8640
8641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8642
8643
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008644timeout connect <timeout>
8645timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8646 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8648 yes | no | yes | yes
8649 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008650 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008651 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8652 as explained at the top of this document.
8653
8654 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008655 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008656 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008657 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008658 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8659 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008660
8661 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8663 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8664 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8665 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8666 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8667
8668 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8669 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8670 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8671
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008672 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8673 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008674
8675
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008676timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8677 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8679 yes | yes | yes | yes
8680 Arguments :
8681 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8682 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8683 as explained at the top of this document.
8684
8685 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8686 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8687 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8688 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8689 once the request has started to present itself.
8690
8691 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8692 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8693 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8694 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8695 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8696
8697 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8698 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8699 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8700 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8701
8702 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8703 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8704 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8705 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8706 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008707 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008708
8709 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8710 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8711 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8712 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8713
8714 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8715
8716
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008717timeout http-request <timeout>
8718 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008721 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008722 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008723 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8724 as explained at the top of this document.
8725
8726 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8727 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8728 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8729 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8730 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8731 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8732 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008733 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8734 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8735 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8736 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8737 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008738 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8739 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008740
8741 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8742 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008743 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8744 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008745
8746 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8747 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8748 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8749 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8750 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8751
8752 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008753 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8754 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8755 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008756
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008757 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8758 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008759
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008760
8761timeout queue <timeout>
8762 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8764 yes | no | yes | yes
8765 Arguments :
8766 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8767 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8768 as explained at the top of this document.
8769
8770 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8771 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8772 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8773 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8774 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8775
8776 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8777 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8778 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8779 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8780
8781 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8782
8783
8784timeout server <timeout>
8785timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8786 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8788 yes | no | yes | yes
8789 Arguments :
8790 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8792 as explained at the top of this document.
8793
8794 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8795 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8796 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8797 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8798 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8799 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8800 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8801
8802 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8803 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8804 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8805 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8806 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008807 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008808 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008809 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8810 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8811 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8812 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008813
8814 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8815 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8816 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8817 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8818 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8819 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8820
8821 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8822 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8823 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8824
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008825 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008826
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008827
8828timeout server-fin <timeout>
8829 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8831 yes | no | yes | yes
8832 Arguments :
8833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8835 as explained at the top of this document.
8836
8837 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8838 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8839 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8840 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8841 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8842 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8843 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8844 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8845 situations, it should not be needed.
8846
8847 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8848 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8849 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8850
8851 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8852
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008853
8854timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008855 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8857 yes | yes | yes | yes
8858 Arguments :
8859 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8860 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8861 as explained at the top of this document.
8862
8863 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8864 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8865 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8866
8867 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8868 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8869 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8870 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008871 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008872
8873 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8874
8875
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008876timeout tunnel <timeout>
8877 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8879 yes | no | yes | yes
8880 Arguments :
8881 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8882 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8883 as explained at the top of this document.
8884
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008885 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008886 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8887 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8888 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8889 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8890 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8891 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8892 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8893 specified.
8894
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008895 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8896 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8897 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8898 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8899 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8900 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8901 state.
8902
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008903 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8904 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8905 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8906 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8907 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8908
8909 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8910 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8911 forget about it.
8912
8913 Example :
8914 defaults http
8915 option http-server-close
8916 timeout connect 5s
8917 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008918 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008919 timeout server 30s
8920 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8921
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008922 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008923
8924
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008925transparent (deprecated)
8926 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008928 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008929 Arguments : none
8930
8931 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8932 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8933 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8934 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8935 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8936 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8937 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8938 appropriate server.
8939
8940 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8941
8942 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8943 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8944
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008945 See also: "option transparent"
8946
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008947unique-id-format <string>
8948 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8950 yes | yes | yes | no
8951 Arguments :
8952 <string> is a log-format string.
8953
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008954 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8955 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8956 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8957 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008958
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008959 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8960 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8961 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8962 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8963 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8964 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8965 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8966 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008967
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008968 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8969 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008970
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008971 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008972
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008973 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008974
8975 will generate:
8976
8977 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8978
8979 See also: "unique-id-header"
8980
8981unique-id-header <name>
8982 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8984 yes | yes | yes | no
8985 Arguments :
8986 <name> is the name of the header.
8987
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008988 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8989 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008990
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008991 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008992
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008993 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008994 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8995
8996 will generate:
8997
8998 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8999
9000 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009001
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009002use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009003 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9005 no | yes | yes | no
9006 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009007 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9008 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009009
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009010 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9011 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009012
9013 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9014 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9015 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009016 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9017 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9018 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9019 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009020
9021 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9022 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9023 assign the backend.
9024
9025 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9026 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9027 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9028 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9029 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9030 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9031
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009032 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009033 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009034 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9035 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9036 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9037
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009038 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9039 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9040 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9041 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9042 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9043 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9044 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9045 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9046 cannot be forced from the request.
9047
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009048 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009049 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9050 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9051
9052 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9053 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009054
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009055
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009056use-server <server> if <condition>
9057use-server <server> unless <condition>
9058 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9060 no | no | yes | yes
9061 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009062 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009063
9064 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9065
9066 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9067 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9068 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9069
9070 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9071 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9072 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9073 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9074 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9075 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9076 matches will assign the server.
9077
9078 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9079 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9080 with the next rules until one matches.
9081
9082 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9083 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9084 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9085 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9086
9087 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9088 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9089 stripped.
9090
9091 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9092 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9093 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9094 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9095
9096 Example :
9097 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9098 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9099 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9100 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9101 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9102 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9103 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9104 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9105 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9106
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009107 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009108
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009109
91105. Bind and Server options
9111--------------------------
9112
9113The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9114depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9115settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9116written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9117described in this section.
9118
9119
91205.1. Bind options
9121-----------------
9122
9123The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9124as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9125no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9126parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9127while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9128provided immediately after the setting name.
9129
9130The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9131
9132accept-proxy
9133 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009134 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9135 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009136 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9137 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9138 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9139 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9140 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9141 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9142 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009143 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9144 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009145
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009146alpn <protocols>
9147 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9148 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9149 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9150 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9151 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9152 initial NPN extension.
9153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009154backlog <backlog>
9155 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9156 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9157
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009158ecdhe <named curve>
9159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009160 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9161 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009162
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009163ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9165 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9166 client's certificate.
9167
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009168ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9170 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9171 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9172 error is ignored.
9173
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009174ca-sign-file <cafile>
9175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9176 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9177 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9178 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9179 'generate-certificates' for details.
9180
9181ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9183 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9184 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9185 'generate-certificates' for details.
9186
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009187ciphers <ciphers>
9188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9189 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009190 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009191 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9192 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9193
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009194crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009195 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9196 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9197 to verify client's certificate.
9198
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009199crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009200 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9201 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9202 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9203 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9204 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9205 file.
9206
9207 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9208 are loaded.
9209
9210 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009211 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009212 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9213 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9214 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9215 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9216 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9217 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9218 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009219
9220 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9221 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9222 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9223 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009224 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9225 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009226
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009227 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009228
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009229 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9230 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009231 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009232 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9233 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9234 clients).
9235
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009236 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9237 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9238 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9239 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9240 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9241 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9242 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9243 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9244 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9245 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9246 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9247 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9248 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9249
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009250 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9251 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9252 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9253 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9254 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9255
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009256crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9258 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009259 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009260 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009261
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009262crt-list <file>
9263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009264 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9265 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009266
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009267 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009268
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009269 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9270 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9271 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9272 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9273 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9274 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9275 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9276 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009277
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009278defer-accept
9279 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9280 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9281 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9282 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9283 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9284 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9285 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9286 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9287 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9288 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9289 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9290
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009291force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009292 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009293 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009294 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9295 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009296
9297force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009298 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009299 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9300 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009301
9302force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009303 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009304 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9305 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009306
9307force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009308 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009309 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9310 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009311
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009312generate-certificates
9313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9314 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9315 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9316 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9317 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9318 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9319 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9320 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9321 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9322 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9323 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9324
9325 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9326 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9327 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9328 certificate is used many times.
9329
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009330gid <gid>
9331 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9332 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9333 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9334 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9335 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9336
9337group <group>
9338 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9339 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9340 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9341 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9342 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9343
9344id <id>
9345 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9346 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9347 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9348 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9349
9350interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009351 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9352 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9353 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9354 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9355 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9356 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9357 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009358
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009359level <level>
9360 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9361 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9362 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9363 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9364 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9365 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9366 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9367 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9368 counters).
9369 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9370 all counters).
9371
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009372maxconn <maxconn>
9373 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9374 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9375 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9376 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9377 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9378 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9379 eat all memory.
9380
9381mode <mode>
9382 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9383 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9384 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9385 UNIX sockets.
9386
9387mss <maxseg>
9388 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9389 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9390 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9391 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9392 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9393 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9394 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9395 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9396 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9397 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9398 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9399
9400name <name>
9401 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9402 page.
9403
9404nice <nice>
9405 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9406 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9407 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9408 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9409 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9410 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9411 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9412 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9413 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9414 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9415 one for an RDP socket.
9416
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009417no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009419 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009420 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009421 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9422 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009423 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009424
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009425no-tls-tickets
9426 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9427 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9428 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009429 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9430 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009431
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009432no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009433 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009434 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009435 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009436 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9437 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9438 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009439
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009440no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009442 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009443 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009444 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9445 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9446 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009447
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009448no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009449 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009450 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009451 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009452 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9453 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9454 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009455
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009456npn <protocols>
9457 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9458 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9459 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9460 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009461 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9462 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009463
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009464process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9465 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9466 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9467 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9468 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9469 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9470 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9471 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009472 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9473 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9474 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9475 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9476 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9477 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9478 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009479
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009480ssl
9481 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009482 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009483 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9484 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9485 to deciphered contents.
9486
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009487strict-sni
9488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9489 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9490 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9491 See the "crt" option for more information.
9492
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009493tcp-ut <delay>
9494 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9495 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9496 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9497 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9498 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9499 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9500 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9501 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9502 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9503 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9504 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9505
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009506tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009507 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009508 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9509 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9510 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9511 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9512 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9513 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9514 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009515 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9516 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9517 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009518
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009519tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9520 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9521 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9522 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9523 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9524 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9525 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9526 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9527 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9528 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9529 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9530
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009531transparent
9532 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9533 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9534 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9535 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9536 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9537 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9538 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9539 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9540 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9541 so check for support with your vendor.
9542
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009543v4v6
9544 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9545 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9546 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9547 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009548 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009549
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009550v6only
9551 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9552 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9553 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009554 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9555 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009556
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009557uid <uid>
9558 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9559 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9560 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9561 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9562 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9563
9564user <user>
9565 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9566 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9567 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9568 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9569 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9570
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009571verify [none|optional|required]
9572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9573 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9574 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9575 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9576 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009577 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9578 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9579 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9580 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020095825.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009583------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009585The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9586which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9587arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9588settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9589after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9590Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9591address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009593 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009594 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009596The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009597
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009598addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009599 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9600 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9601 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9602 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9603 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009605 Supported in default-server: No
9606
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009607agent-check
9608 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009609 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9610 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9611 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9612 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009613
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009614 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009615 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009616 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9617 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9618 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009619
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009620 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9621 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009622
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009623 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9624 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9625 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009626
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009627 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9628 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9629 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009630
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009631 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9632 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9633 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9634 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9635 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9636 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9637 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009638
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009639 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9640 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009641
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009642 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9643 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9644 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9645 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9646 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9647 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9648 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9649 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9650 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009651
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009652 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9653 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009654 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9655 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9656 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9657 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009658
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009659 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9660 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009661
9662 Supported in default-server: No
9663
9664agent-inter <delay>
9665 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9666 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9667
9668 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9669 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9670 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9671 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9672 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9673 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9674 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9675 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9676 of backends use the same servers.
9677
9678 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9679
9680 Supported in default-server: Yes
9681
9682agent-port <port>
9683 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9684
9685 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9686
9687 Supported in default-server: Yes
9688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009689backup
9690 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9691 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9692 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9693 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9694 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9695 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009697 Supported in default-server: No
9698
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009699ca-file <cafile>
9700 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9701 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9702 server's certificate.
9703
9704 Supported in default-server: No
9705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009706check
9707 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009708 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9709 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9710 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9711 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9712 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9713 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9714 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009715 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9716 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9717 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009719 Supported in default-server: No
9720
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009721check-send-proxy
9722 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9723 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9724 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9725 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9726 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9727 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9728 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9729
9730 Supported in default-server: No
9731
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009732check-ssl
9733 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9734 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9735 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9736 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009737 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009738 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9739 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9740 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9741 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9742
9743 Supported in default-server: No
9744
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009745ciphers <ciphers>
9746 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009747 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009748 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9749 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9750 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9751 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9752 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9753 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9754
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009755 Supported in default-server: No
9756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009757cookie <value>
9758 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9759 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9760 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9761 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9762 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9763 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9764 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009766 Supported in default-server: No
9767
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009768crl-file <crlfile>
9769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9770 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9771 to verify server's certificate.
9772
9773 Supported in default-server: No
9774
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009775crt <cert>
9776 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9777 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9778 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9779 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9780 certificate request.
9781
9782 Supported in default-server: No
9783
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009784disabled
9785 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9786 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9787 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9788 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9789 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9790
9791 Supported in default-server: No
9792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009793error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009794 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9795 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9796 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009798 Supported in default-server: Yes
9799
9800 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009802fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009803 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9804 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9805 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009807 Supported in default-server: Yes
9808
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009809force-sslv3
9810 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9811 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009812 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9813 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009814
9815 Supported in default-server: No
9816
9817force-tlsv10
9818 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009819 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9820 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009821
9822 Supported in default-server: No
9823
9824force-tlsv11
9825 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009826 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9827 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009828
9829 Supported in default-server: No
9830
9831force-tlsv12
9832 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009833 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9834 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009835
9836 Supported in default-server: No
9837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009838id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009839 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9840 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9841 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009843 Supported in default-server: No
9844
9845inter <delay>
9846fastinter <delay>
9847downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009848 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9849 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9850 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9851 between checks depending on the server state :
9852
9853 Server state | Interval used
9854 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9855 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9856 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9857 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9858 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9859 or yet unchecked. |
9860 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9861 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9862 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009864 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9865 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9866 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9867 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009868 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9869 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9870 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9871 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9872 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009873
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009874 Supported in default-server: Yes
9875
9876maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009877 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9878 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9879 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9880 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9881 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9882 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9883 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9884 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009886 Supported in default-server: Yes
9887
9888maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009889 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9890 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9891 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9892 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9893 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9894 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9895 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9896
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009897 Supported in default-server: Yes
9898
9899minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009900 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9901 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9902 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9903 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9904 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9905 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009906 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009907 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009909 Supported in default-server: Yes
9910
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009911no-ssl-reuse
9912 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9913 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9914 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9915 and for paranoid users.
9916
9917 Supported in default-server: No
9918
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009919no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009920 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9921 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009922 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009923
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009924 Supported in default-server: No
9925
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009926no-tls-tickets
9927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9928 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9929 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009930 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9931 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009932
9933 Supported in default-server: No
9934
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009935no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009936 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009937 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9938 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009939 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9940 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9941 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009942
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009943 Supported in default-server: No
9944
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009945no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009946 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009947 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9948 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009949 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9950 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9951 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009952
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009953 Supported in default-server: No
9954
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009955no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009956 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009957 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9958 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009959 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9960 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9961 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009962
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009963 Supported in default-server: No
9964
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009965non-stick
9966 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9967 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9968 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9969
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009970 Supported in default-server: No
9971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009972observe <mode>
9973 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9974 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9975 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9976 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9977 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9978 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009979 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009981 Supported in default-server: No
9982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009983 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009985on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009986 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9987 Currently, four modes are available:
9988 - fastinter: force fastinter
9989 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9990 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9991 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9992 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009994 Supported in default-server: Yes
9995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009996 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9997
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009998on-marked-down <action>
9999 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10000 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010001 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10002 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10003 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10004 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10005 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10006 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10007 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10008 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010009
10010 Actions are disabled by default
10011
10012 Supported in default-server: Yes
10013
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010014on-marked-up <action>
10015 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10016 Currently one action is available:
10017 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10018 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10019 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10020 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10021 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10022 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10023 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10024 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10025
10026 Actions are disabled by default
10027
10028 Supported in default-server: Yes
10029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010030port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010031 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10032 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10033 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10034 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10035 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10036 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010038 Supported in default-server: Yes
10039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010040redir <prefix>
10041 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10042 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10043 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10044 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10045 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10046 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10047 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10048 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010049 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010050 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10051 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10052 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10053 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10054 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10055
10056 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010058 Supported in default-server: No
10059
10060rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010061 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10062 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10063 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010065 Supported in default-server: Yes
10066
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010067resolve-prefer <family>
10068 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10069 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10070 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10071 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10072
10073 Default value: ipv4
10074
10075 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10076
10077resolvers <id>
10078 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10079 hostname.
10080
10081 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns
10082
10083 See also chapter 5.3
10084
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010085send-proxy
10086 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10087 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10088 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10089 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10090 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10091 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10092 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10093 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10094 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010095 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10096 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10097 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10098 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10099 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010100
10101 Supported in default-server: No
10102
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010103send-proxy-v2
10104 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10105 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10106 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10107 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10108 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10109 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10110 option of the "bind" keyword.
10111
10112 Supported in default-server: No
10113
10114send-proxy-v2-ssl
10115 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10116 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10117 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10118 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10119 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10120 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10121 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10122 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10123
10124 Supported in default-server: No
10125
10126send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10127 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10128 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10129 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10130 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10131 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10132 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10133 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10134 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10135 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10136
10137 Supported in default-server: No
10138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010139slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010140 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10141 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10142 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10143 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10144 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10145 parameters :
10146
10147 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10148 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10149
10150 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10151 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10152 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10153 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10154
10155 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10156 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10157 seen as failed.
10158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010159 Supported in default-server: Yes
10160
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010161source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010162source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010163source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010164 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10165 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10166 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10167 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10168
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010169 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10170 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10171 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10172 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10173 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10174 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10175 server.
10176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010177 Supported in default-server: No
10178
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010179ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010180 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10181 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10182 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10183 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10184 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10185 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010186 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010187
10188 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010190track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010191 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10192 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10193 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10194 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010195 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010197 Supported in default-server: No
10198
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010199verify [none|required]
10200 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010201 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10202 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10203 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10204 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010205 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10206 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10207 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010208
10209 Supported in default-server: No
10210
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010211verifyhost <hostname>
10212 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10213 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10214 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10215 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10216 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10217 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10218
10219 Supported in default-server: No
10220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010221weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010222 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10223 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10224 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010225 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10226 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10227 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10228 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10229 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10230 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010232 Supported in default-server: Yes
10233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010234
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200102355.3 Server IP address resolution using DNS
10236------------------------------------------
10237
10238HAProxy allows using a host name to be resolved to find out what is the server
10239IP address. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10240configuration, at startup.
10241This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10242can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10243workload.
10244This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10245resolution at run time.
10246Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10247carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10248
10249
102505.3.1 Global overview
10251---------------------
10252
10253As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10254different steps of the process life:
10255
10256 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10257 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10258 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10259
10260 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10261 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10262 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10263
10264A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10265 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10266 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10267 resolution to know this new IP.
10268
10269A few things important to notice:
10270 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10271 first valid response.
10272
10273 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10274 servers return an error.
10275
10276
102775.3.2 The resolvers section
10278---------------------------
10279
10280This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10281HAProxy.
10282There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10283many name servers.
10284
10285resolvers <resolvers id>
10286 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10287
10288A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10289
10290nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10291 DNS server description:
10292 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10293 <ip> : IP address of the server
10294 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10295
10296hold <status> <period>
10297 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10298 on last resolution <status>
10299 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10300 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10301 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10302 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10303
10304 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10305
10306 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10307 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10308 the healch check.
10309
10310resolve_retries <nb>
10311 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10312 giving up.
10313 Default value: 3
10314
10315timeout <event> <time>
10316 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10317 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10318 events available are:
10319 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10320 been received.
10321 Default value: 1s
10322 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10323 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10324
10325Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10326
10327 resolvers mydns
10328 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10329 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10330 resolve_retries 3
10331 timeout retry 1s
10332 hold valid 10s
10333
10334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103356. HTTP header manipulation
10336---------------------------
10337
10338In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10339response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10340request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10341which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010342against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010343
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010344If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10345to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10346but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10347HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10348stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10349because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10350a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10351still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010353This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10354in section 4.2 :
10355
10356 - reqadd <string>
10357 - reqallow <search>
10358 - reqiallow <search>
10359 - reqdel <search>
10360 - reqidel <search>
10361 - reqdeny <search>
10362 - reqideny <search>
10363 - reqpass <search>
10364 - reqipass <search>
10365 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10366 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10367 - reqtarpit <search>
10368 - reqitarpit <search>
10369 - rspadd <string>
10370 - rspdel <search>
10371 - rspidel <search>
10372 - rspdeny <search>
10373 - rspideny <search>
10374 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10375 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10376
10377With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10378is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10379parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10380prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10381Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10382
10383 \t for a tab
10384 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10385 \n for a new line (LF)
10386 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10387 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10388 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10389 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10390 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10391
10392The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10393portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10394above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10395regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
103969 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10397is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10398
10399The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10400after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10401
10402Notes related to these keywords :
10403---------------------------------
10404 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10405 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10406 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10407
10408 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10409 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10410 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10411
10412 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10413 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10414 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10415 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10416 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10417
10418 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10419 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10420 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10421 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10422 useless headers before adding new ones.
10423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010424 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010425 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10426
10427 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10428 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10429 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10430
10431 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10432 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010433 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010434
10435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104367. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10437----------------------------------
10438
10439Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10440client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10441The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10442these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10443but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10444data called patterns.
10445
10446
104477.1. ACL basics
10448---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010449
10450The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10451content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10452from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10453simple :
10454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010455 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010456 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010457 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10458 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010460The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10461adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010462
10463In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010465 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010466
10467This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10468Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10469and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010470an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10471conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10472as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10473are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010474
10475ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10476'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10477which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10478
10479There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10480performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10483specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10484this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010485methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10486ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487
10488Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10489 - boolean
10490 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10491 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10492 - string
10493 - data block
10494
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010495Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10496converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10497would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10498The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10499which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10500
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010501Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10502keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10503fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10504which are summarized in the table below :
10505
10506 +---------------------+-----------------+
10507 | Sample or converter | Default |
10508 | output type | matching method |
10509 +---------------------+-----------------+
10510 | boolean | bool |
10511 +---------------------+-----------------+
10512 | integer | int |
10513 +---------------------+-----------------+
10514 | ip | ip |
10515 +---------------------+-----------------+
10516 | string | str |
10517 +---------------------+-----------------+
10518 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10519 +---------------------+-----------------+
10520
10521Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10522matching method, see below.
10523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010524The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10525 - boolean
10526 - integer or integer range
10527 - IP address / network
10528 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10529 - regular expression
10530 - hex block
10531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010532The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10533
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010534 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10535 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010537 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010538 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010539 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010540 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10543read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10544if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10545lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10546will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10547beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10548a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10549lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10550exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10551
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010552The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10553parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10554ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10555a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10556check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10557
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010558The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10559socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10560file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010562Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10563loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10564
10565 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10566
10567In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10568the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10569case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10570as well.
10571
10572The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10573sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10574do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10575methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10576is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10577obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10578followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10579default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10580that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10581string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10582
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010583The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10584By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10585string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10586resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10587server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10588waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10589flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10590function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010592There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10593sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10594be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010595
10596 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10597 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010598 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10599 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10600 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10601 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010602
10603 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10604 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010606
10607 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010609
10610 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010611 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010612
10613 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10614 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10615
10616 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10617 binary or string samples.
10618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010619 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10620 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010622 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10623 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10624 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10627 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10630 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010632 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10633 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010635 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10636 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010637 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010639 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10640 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10641 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010642
10643For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10644request, it is possible to do :
10645
10646 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10647
10648In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10649buffer, one would use the following acl :
10650
10651 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10652
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010653On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10654possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10655
10656 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010658All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10659criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10660method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10661to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10662criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10663the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010665If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010666the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10667For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10670 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10671 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10672 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010673
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010674
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010675The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10676types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10677combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10678brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10679default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010681 +-------------------------------------------------+
10682 | Input sample type |
10683 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010684 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010685 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10686 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10687 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010688 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010689 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010690 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010691 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010692 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010694 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010696 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010698 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010700 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010702 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010704 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010706 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010708 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10710 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010712
10713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107147.1.1. Matching booleans
10715------------------------
10716
10717In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10718Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10719When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10720that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10721
10722Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10723return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10724"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107277.1.2. Matching integers
10728------------------------
10729
10730Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10731enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10732to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10733
10734Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10735matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10736lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010737
10738For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10739unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10740representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10741
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010742As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10743two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10744instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10745ranges and operators.
10746
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010747For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010748operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10749Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10750of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010752Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010753
10754 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10755 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10756 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10757 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10758 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010760For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010761
10762 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10763
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010764This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10765
10766 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107697.1.3. Matching strings
10770-----------------------
10771
10772String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10773different forms :
10774
10775 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10776 patterns ;
10777
10778 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10779 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10780
10781 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10782 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10783
10784 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10785 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10786
10787 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10788 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10789 matches.
10790
10791 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10792 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10793 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010794
10795String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10796exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10797characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10798string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10799to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010800before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010801
10802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108037.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10804---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010805
10806Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10807they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10808possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10809passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10810the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010811the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10812match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010813
10814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108157.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10816-------------------------------------
10817
10818It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10819not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10820a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10821to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10822digits may be used upper or lower case.
10823
10824Example :
10825 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10826 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10827
10828
108297.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10830---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010831
10832IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10833netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10834within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010835host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010836difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10837at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10838does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10839parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010840
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010841IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10842Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10843trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10844IPv6 patterns.
10845
10846HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10847following situations :
10848 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10849 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10850 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10851 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10852 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10853 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10854 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10855 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10856 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10857 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010859
108607.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10861----------------------------------
10862
10863Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10864combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10865
10866 - AND (implicit)
10867 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10868 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010870A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010872 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010874Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10875indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010877For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10878"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10879requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10880is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10881
10882 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10883 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10884 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10885 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10886
10887To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10888and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10889
10890 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10891 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10892 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10893 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10894
10895 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10896 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10897 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10898 use_backend www if host_www
10899
10900It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10901expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10902be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10903the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10904
10905 The following rule :
10906
10907 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10908 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10909
10910 Can also be written that way :
10911
10912 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10913
10914It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10915to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10916simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10917sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10918good use is the following :
10919
10920 With named ACLs :
10921
10922 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10923 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10924 monitor fail if site_dead
10925
10926 With anonymous ACLs :
10927
10928 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10929
10930See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10931
10932
109337.3. Fetching samples
10934---------------------
10935
10936Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10937against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10938sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10939ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10940of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10941available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10942
10943This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10944Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10945compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10946deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10947
10948The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10949matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10950method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10951indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10952
10953As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10954when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10955mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10956the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10957ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10958
10959Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10960multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10961when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10962incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10963are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10964is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10965all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10966
10967Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10968 - name
10969 - name(arg1)
10970 - name(arg1,arg2)
10971
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010972
109737.3.1. Converters
10974-----------------
10975
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010976Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10977of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10978is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10979was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10980has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10981unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10982
10983These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10984sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10985the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10986support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010987
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010988A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10989support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10990supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10991(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10992bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010995
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010996add(<value>)
10997 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10998 result as an unsigned integer.
10999
11000and(<value>)
11001 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11002 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11003
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011004base64
11005 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11006 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11007 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11008
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011009bool
11010 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11011 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11012 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11013 presence of a flag).
11014
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011015bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11016 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11017 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11018 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11019
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011020cpl
11021 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
11022 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11023
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011024crc32([<avalanche>])
11025 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11026 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11027 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11028 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11029 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11030 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11031 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11032 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11033 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11034 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11035 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11036
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011037da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
11038 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11039 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11040 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11041 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11042 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11043 configuration language.
11044
11045 Example:
11046 frontend www
11047 bind *:8881
11048 default_backend servers
11049 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
11050
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011051debug
11052 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11053 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11054 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11055
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011056div(<value>)
11057 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11058 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
11059 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
11060
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011061djb2([<avalanche>])
11062 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11063 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11064 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11065 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11066 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11067 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11068 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011069 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11070 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011071
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011072even
11073 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
11074 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11075
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011076field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11077 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11078 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11079 list of chars.
11080
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011081hex
11082 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11083 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11084 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11085 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011087http_date([<offset>])
11088 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11089 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11090 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11091 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11092 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11093 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011095in_table(<table>)
11096 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11097 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11098 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11099 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11100 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11101
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011102ipmask(<mask>)
11103 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11104 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11105 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11106 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11107
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011108json([<input-code>])
11109 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11110 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11111 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11112 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11113 of errors:
11114 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11115 bytes, ...)
11116 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11117 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11118
11119 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11120 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11121 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11122 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11123 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11124 are :
11125 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11126 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11127 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11128 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11129 error ;
11130 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11131 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11132
11133 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11134 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11135
11136 Example:
11137 capture request header user-agent len 150
11138 capture request header Host len 15
11139 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11140
11141 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11142 GET / HTTP/1.0
11143 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11144
11145 Output log:
11146 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11147
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011148language(<value>[,<default>])
11149 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11150 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11151 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11152 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11153 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11154 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11155 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11156 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11157 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11158 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11159 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11160 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011161
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011162 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011163
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011164 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11165 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011166
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011167 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11168 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11169 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11170 use_backend spanish if es
11171 use_backend french if fr
11172 use_backend english if en
11173 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011174
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011175lower
11176 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11177 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11178 type. The result is of type string.
11179
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011180ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11181 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11182 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11183 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11184 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11185 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11186 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11187
11188 Example :
11189
11190 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11191 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11192 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11193
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011194map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11195map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11196map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11197 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11198 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11199 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11200 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11201 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11202 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11203 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11204 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011205
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011206 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11207 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11208 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011209
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011210 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11211 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011213 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11214 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11215 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11216 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011217 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11218 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011219 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11220 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11221 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11222 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11223 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11224 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11225 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11226 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11227 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11228 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11229 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11230 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11231 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11232 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011234 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11235 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11236 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11237 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11238 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011239
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011240 Example :
11241
11242 # this is a comment and is ignored
11243 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11244 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11245 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11246 | | | `---------- value
11247 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11248 | `---------------------------- key
11249 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11250
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011251mod(<value>)
11252 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11253 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
11254
11255mul(<value>)
11256 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
11257 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
11258 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
11259
11260neg
11261 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
11262 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
11263 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
11264 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11265
11266not
11267 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11268 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11269 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11270 absence of a flag).
11271
11272odd
11273 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
11274 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11275
11276or(<value>)
11277 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11278 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11279
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011280regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011281 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11282 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11283 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11284 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11285 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11286 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11287 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11288 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11289 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11290 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11291 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11292 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11293 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11294
11295 Example :
11296
11297 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11298 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11299 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11300 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11301
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011302capture-req(<id>)
11303 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11304 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11305
11306 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11307 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11308 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11309
11310capture-res(<id>)
11311 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11312 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11313
11314 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11315 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11316 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11317
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011318sdbm([<avalanche>])
11319 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11320 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11321 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11322 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11323 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11324 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11325 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011326 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11327 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011328
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011329set-var(<var name>)
11330 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11331 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11332 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11333 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11334 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11335 response),
11336 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11337 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11338 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11339 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11340
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011341sub(<value>)
11342 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
11343 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
11344 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11345
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011346table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11347 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11348 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11349 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11350 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11351 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11352 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11353
11354
11355table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11356 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11357 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11358 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11359 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11360 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11361 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11362
11363table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11364 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11365 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11366 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11367 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11368 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11369
11370table_conn_cur(<table>)
11371 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11372 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11373 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11374 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11375 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11376
11377table_conn_rate(<table>)
11378 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11379 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11380 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11381 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11382 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11383
11384table_gpc0(<table>)
11385 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11386 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11387 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11388 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11389 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11390
11391table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11392 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11393 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11394 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11395 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11396 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11397 sample fetch keyword.
11398
11399table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11400 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11401 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11402 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11403 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11404 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11405
11406table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11407 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11408 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11409 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11410 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11411 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11412 keyword.
11413
11414table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11415 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11416 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11417 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11418 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11419 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11420
11421table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11422 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11423 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11424 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11425 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11426 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11427 keyword.
11428
11429table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11430 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11431 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11432 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11433 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11434 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11435 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11436 keyword.
11437
11438table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11439 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11440 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11441 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11442 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11443 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11444 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11445 keyword.
11446
11447table_server_id(<table>)
11448 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11449 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11450 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11451 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11452 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11453 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11454
11455table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11456 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11457 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11458 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11459 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11460 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11461 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11462 keyword.
11463
11464table_sess_rate(<table>)
11465 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11466 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11467 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11468 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11469 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11470 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11471 keyword.
11472
11473table_trackers(<table>)
11474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11477 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11478 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11479 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11480 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11481 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11482 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11483 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11484
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011485upper
11486 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11487 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11488 type. The result is of type string.
11489
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011490url_dec
11491 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11492 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11493
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011494utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11495 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11496 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11497 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11498 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11499 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11500 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11501
11502 Example :
11503
11504 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11505 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11506 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11507
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011508word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11509 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11510 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11511
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011512wt6([<avalanche>])
11513 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11514 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11515 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11516 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11517 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11518 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11519 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011520 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11521 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011522
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011523xor(<value>)
11524 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11525 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11526
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011527
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115287.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011529--------------------------------------------
11530
11531A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11532not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11533"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11534The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11535
11536always_false : boolean
11537 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11538 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11539
11540always_true : boolean
11541 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11542 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11543
11544avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011545 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11547 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11548 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11549 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11550 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11551 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11552 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11553 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11554 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11555 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11556 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11557 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11558 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011561 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11562 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11563 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11564 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11565 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011567be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11568 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11569 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11570 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11571 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11572 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11573 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011574
11575 Example :
11576 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11577 backend dynamic
11578 mode http
11579 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11580 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011581
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011582bin(<hexa>) : bin
11583 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
11584 of the string.
11585
11586bool(<bool>) : bool
11587 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
11588 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
11589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011590connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011592 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011593 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11594 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011595
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011596 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011597 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011598 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11599
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011600 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11601 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011602
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011603 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011604 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011605 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011606 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11607 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011608 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011609 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011610
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011611 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11612 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011614 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011615
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011616date([<offset>]) : integer
11617 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11618 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11619 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11620 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011621 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11622
11623 Example :
11624
11625 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11626 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011627
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011628env(<name>) : string
11629 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11630 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11631 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11632 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11633 certain way.
11634
11635 Examples :
11636 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11637 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11638
11639 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11640 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011642fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11643 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011644 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11645 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011646 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11647 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11648 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11649 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11650 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011652fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11653 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11654 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11655 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11656 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11657 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11658 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11659 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11660 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011661
11662 Example :
11663 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11664 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11665 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11666 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11667 frontend mail
11668 bind :25
11669 mode tcp
11670 maxconn 100
11671 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11672 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11673 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11674 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011675
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011676ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
11677 Returns an ipv4.
11678
11679ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
11680 Returns an ipv6.
11681
11682meth(<method>) : method
11683 Returns a method.
11684
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011685nbproc : integer
11686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11687 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11688 and debugging purposes.
11689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011690nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11691 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11692 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11693 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011694 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11695 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11696 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011697
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011698proc : integer
11699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11700 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11701 debugging purposes.
11702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011703queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011704 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11705 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11706 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011707 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11708 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11709 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11710 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11711 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11712
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011713rand([<range>]) : integer
11714 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11715 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11716 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11717 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11718 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11719
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011720sint(<sint>) : signed integer
11721 Returns a signed integer.
11722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011723srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11725 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11726 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11727 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11728 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11729 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11730 methods.
11731
11732srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11733 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11734 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11735 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11736 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11737 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11738 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11739 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11740
11741srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11742 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11743 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011744 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011745 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11746 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11747 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11748 overloading servers).
11749
11750 Example :
11751 # Redirect to a separate back
11752 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11753 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11754 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11755
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011756stopping : boolean
11757 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11758 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11759 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11760
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011761str(<string>) : string
11762 Returns a string.
11763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011764table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11765 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11766 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11767
11768table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11769 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11770 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11771 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11772
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011773uint(<uint>) : unsigned integer
11774 Returns an unsigned integer.
11775
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011776var(<var-name>) : undefined
11777 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
11778 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11779 scope. The scope allowed are:
11780 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11781 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11782 response),
11783 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11784 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11785 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11786 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011788
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011790----------------------------------
11791
11792The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11793closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11794methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11795sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11796TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011797the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11798counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11799"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011800argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11801the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11802this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011803
11804be_id : integer
11805 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11806 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11807
11808dst : ip
11809 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11810 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11811 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11812 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11813 RFC 4291.
11814
11815dst_conn : integer
11816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11817 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11818 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11819 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11820 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11821 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11822 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11823 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011825dst_port : integer
11826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11827 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11828 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11829 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11830 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11831 an HTTP header.
11832
11833fe_id : integer
11834 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11835 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11836 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11837
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011838sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011839sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11840sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11841sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011842 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11843 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11844 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11845
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011846sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011847sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11848sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11849sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011850 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11851 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11852 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11853
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011854sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011855sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11856sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11857sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011858 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11859 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011860 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11861 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11862 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011863
11864 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11865 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011866 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11867 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11868 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011869 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11870 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011872sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011873sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11874sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11875sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011876 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11877 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011879sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011880sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11881sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11882sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011883 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11884 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11885 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11886
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011887sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011888sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11889sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11890sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011891 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11892 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11893 See also src_conn_rate.
11894
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011895sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011896sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11897sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11898sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011899 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011900 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011901
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011902sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011903sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11904sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11905sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011906 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11907 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11908 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011909 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11910 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11911 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011913sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011914sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11915sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11916sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011917 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11918 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11919 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011921sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011922sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11923sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11924sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011925 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11926 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11927 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11928 src_http_err_rate.
11929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011930sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011931sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11932sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11933sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011934 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11935 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11936 src_http_req_cnt.
11937
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011938sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011939sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11940sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11941sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011942 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11943 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11944 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11945 src_http_req_rate.
11946
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011947sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011948sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11949sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11950sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011951 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011952 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11953 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11954 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11955 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011956
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011957 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11958 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011959 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011961sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011962sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11963sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11964sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011965 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11966 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11967 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011968
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011969sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011970sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11971sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11972sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011973 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11974 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11975 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011976
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011977sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011978sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11979sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11980sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011981 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11982 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11983 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11984 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011985 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011986 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11987
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011988sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011989sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11990sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11991sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011992 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11993 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11994 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11995 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11996 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011997 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011998
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011999sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012000sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12001sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12002sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012003 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12004 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12005 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012007sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012008sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12009sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12010sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012011 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12012 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012013 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012014 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12015 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12017 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12018 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020so_id : integer
12021 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12022 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12023 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025src : ip
12026 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12027 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12028 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12029 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12030 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12031 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12032 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012033
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012034 Example:
12035 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12036 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012038src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12039 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12040 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12041 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012042 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012044src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12045 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12046 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012047 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012048 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012050src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12051 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12052 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12053 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12054 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12055 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12056 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012057
12058 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12059 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12060 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12061 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012062 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012063 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12064 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012066src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012067 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012068 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012069 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012070 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012072src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012073 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012074 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12075 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012076 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012078src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12079 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12080 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12081 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012082 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012084src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012085 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012086 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012087 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012088 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012090src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012091 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012092 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012093 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12094 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012095 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12096 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12097 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012099src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12100 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12101 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012102 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012103 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012104 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012106src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12107 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12108 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12109 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12110 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012111 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012113src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12114 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12115 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12116 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012117 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012119src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12120 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12121 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12122 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012123 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012124 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012126src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12127 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12128 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12129 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012130 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012131 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12132 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012133
12134 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012135 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012136 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012138src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012139 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12140 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12141 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12142 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12143 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012145src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012146 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12147 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12148 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12149 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12150 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012152src_port : integer
12153 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12154 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12155 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12156 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012158src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12159 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012160 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12161 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12162 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012163 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012165src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12166 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12167 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12168 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12169 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012170 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012172src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12173 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12174 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12175 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12176 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12177 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12178 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12179 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12180 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012181
12182 Example :
12183 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12184 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12185 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12186 listen ssh
12187 bind :22
12188 mode tcp
12189 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012190 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012191 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012192 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012194srv_id : integer
12195 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12196 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12197 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012198
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012199
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200122007.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012201----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012203The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12204closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12205when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12206usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012207future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012208
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012209ssl_bc : boolean
12210 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12211 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12212 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12213
12214ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12215 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12216 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12217
12218ssl_bc_cipher : string
12219 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12220 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12221
12222ssl_bc_protocol : string
12223 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12224 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12225
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012226ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012227 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012228 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12229 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012230
12231ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12232 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12233 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12234 if session was reused or not.
12235
12236ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12237 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12238 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012240ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12241 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12242 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12243 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12244 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12245 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012247ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12248 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12249 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12250 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12251 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012252
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012253ssl_c_der : binary
12254 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12255 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12256 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258ssl_c_err : integer
12259 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12260 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12261 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12262 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12263 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012265ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12266 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12267 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12268 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12269 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12270 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12271 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12272 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12273 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012275ssl_c_key_alg : string
12276 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12277 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12278 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012280ssl_c_notafter : string
12281 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12282 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12283 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012285ssl_c_notbefore : string
12286 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12287 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12288 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012290ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12291 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12292 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12293 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12294 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12295 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12296 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12297 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12298 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012300ssl_c_serial : binary
12301 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12302 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12303 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012305ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12306 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12307 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12308 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012309 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12310 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12311
12312 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012314ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12315 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12316 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12317 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012319ssl_c_used : boolean
12320 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12321 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012323ssl_c_verify : integer
12324 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12325 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12326 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12327 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012329ssl_c_version : integer
12330 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12331 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012332
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012333ssl_f_der : binary
12334 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12335 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12336 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012338ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12339 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12340 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12341 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12342 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012343 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012344 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12345 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12346 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012348ssl_f_key_alg : string
12349 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12350 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12351 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353ssl_f_notafter : string
12354 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12355 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12356 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012358ssl_f_notbefore : string
12359 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12360 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12361 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12364 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12365 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12366 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12367 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12368 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12369 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12370 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12371 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012373ssl_f_serial : binary
12374 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12375 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12376 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012377
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012378ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12379 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12380 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12381 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012383ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12384 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12385 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12386 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012388ssl_f_version : integer
12389 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12390 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12391
12392ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012393 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12394 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12395 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012397 Example :
12398 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12399 listen http-https
12400 bind :80
12401 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12402 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12403
12404ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12405 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12406 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12407
12408ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012409 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012410 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12411 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12412 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12413 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12414 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12415 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12416 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12417 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012419ssl_fc_cipher : string
12420 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12421 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012423ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012424 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12425 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012426 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12427 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12428 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12429 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012431ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12432 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012433 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12434 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12435 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12436 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012437
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012438ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12439 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12440 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012442ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012443 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012444 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12445 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12446 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12447 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12448 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12449 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12450 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012452ssl_fc_protocol : string
12453 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12454 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012455
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012456ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012457 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012458 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12459 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12462 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12463 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12464 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12465 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012467ssl_fc_sni : string
12468 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12469 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12470 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12471 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12472 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12473
12474 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12475 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12476 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012477 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12478 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012480 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012481 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12482 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012484ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12485 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12486 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012487
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012488
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012490------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012492Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12493sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12494only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12495For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12496be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12497can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12498sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12499for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12500content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012502payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12503 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12504 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12505 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012507payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12508 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12509 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12510 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012512req.len : integer
12513req_len : integer (deprecated)
12514 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12515 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12516 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12517 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12518 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12519 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12520 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12521 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012523req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12524 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012525 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12526 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12527 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12528 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012530 ACL alternatives :
12531 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012533req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12534 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12535 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12536 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12537 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012539 ACL alternatives :
12540 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012542 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012544req.proto_http : boolean
12545req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12546 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12547 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12548 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12549 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12550 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12551 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12552 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012554 Example:
12555 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12556 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12557 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012558 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012560req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12561rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12562 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12563 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12564 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12565 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12566 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12567 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12568 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012570 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12571 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12572 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12573 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12574 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12575 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012577 ACL derivatives :
12578 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012580 Example :
12581 listen tse-farm
12582 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12583 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12584 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12585 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12586 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12587 persist rdp-cookie
12588 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12589 # This is only useful makes sense if
12590 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12591 stick-table type string size 204800
12592 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12593 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12594 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012596 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12597 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012599req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12600rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12601 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12602 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12603 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12604 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012606 ACL derivatives :
12607 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012609req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12610req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12611 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12612 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12613 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12614 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12615 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12616 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12617 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012619req.ssl_sni : string
12620req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12621 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12622 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12623 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12624 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12625 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12626 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12627 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12628 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12629 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12630 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12631 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12632 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012634 ACL derivatives :
12635 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012637 Examples :
12638 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12639 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12640 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12641 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12642 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012644res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12645rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12646 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12647 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12648 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12649 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12650 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12651 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12652 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012654req.ssl_ver : integer
12655req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12656 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12657 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12658 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12659 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12660 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12661 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12662 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12663 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12664 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666 ACL derivatives :
12667 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012668
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012669res.len : integer
12670 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12671 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12672 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12673 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12674 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12675 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12676 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12677 content inspection.
12678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012679res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12680 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012681 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12682 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12683 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12684 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012686res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12687 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12688 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12689 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12690 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694wait_end : boolean
12695 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12696 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12697 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12698 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12699 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12700 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12701 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12702 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012704 Examples :
12705 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12706 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12707 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012709 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12710 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12711 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12712 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12713 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12714 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12715 tcp-request content reject
12716
12717
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127187.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012719--------------------------------------
12720
12721It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12722This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12723data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12724its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12725HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12726content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12727to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12728more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12729response are indexed.
12730
12731base : string
12732 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12733 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12734 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12735 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12736 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12737 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12738 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12739 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12740
12741 ACL derivatives :
12742 base : exact string match
12743 base_beg : prefix match
12744 base_dir : subdir match
12745 base_dom : domain match
12746 base_end : suffix match
12747 base_len : length match
12748 base_reg : regex match
12749 base_sub : substring match
12750
12751base32 : integer
12752 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12753 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12754 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012755 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12756 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12757 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012758
12759base32+src : binary
12760 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12761 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12762 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12763 per-URL counters.
12764
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012765capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12766 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12767 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12768 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12769
12770capture.req.method : string
12771 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12772 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12773 because it's allocated.
12774
12775capture.req.uri : string
12776 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12777 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12778 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12779 allocated.
12780
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012781capture.req.ver : string
12782 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12783 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12784 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12785
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012786capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12787 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12788 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12789 The first entry is an index of 0.
12790 See also: "capture response header"
12791
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012792capture.res.ver : string
12793 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12794 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12795 persistent flag.
12796
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012797req.body : binary
12798 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12799 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12800 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12801 the first chunk is analyzed.
12802
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012803req.body_param([<name>) : string
12804 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12805 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12806 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12807 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12808 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12809 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12810 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12811 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12812 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12813 given.
12814
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012815req.body_len : integer
12816 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12817 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12818 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12819 "option http-buffer-request".
12820
12821req.body_size : integer
12822 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12823 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12824 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12825 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12826 "option http-buffer-request".
12827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012828req.cook([<name>]) : string
12829cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12830 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12831 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12832 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12833 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12834 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12835 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12836 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12837 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12838
12839 ACL derivatives :
12840 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12841 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12842 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12843 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12844 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12845 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12846 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12847 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12850cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12851 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12852 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012854req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12855cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12856 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12857 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12858 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12859 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12862 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12863 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12864 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12865 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12866 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12867 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12868 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12869 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12870 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12871 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012873hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12874 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12875 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12876 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12877 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012878 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012880req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12881 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12882 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12883 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12884 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12885 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12886 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12887 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12888 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012890req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12891 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12892 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12893 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12894 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12897 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12898 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12899 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12900 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12901 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12902 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12903 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12904 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12905 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12906 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12907 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012909 ACL derivatives :
12910 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12911 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12912 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12913 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12914 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12915 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12916 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12917 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12918
12919req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12920hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12921 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12922 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12923 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12924 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12925 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12926 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12927 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12928 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12929 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12930
12931req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12932hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12933 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12934 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12935 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12936 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12937 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12938 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12939 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12940 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12941
12942req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12943hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12944 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12945 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12946 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12947 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12948 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12949 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12950 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12951
12952http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12953 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12954 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12955 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12956 basic auth is supported.
12957
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012958http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12959 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12960 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12961 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12962 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12964 basic auth is supported.
12965
12966 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012967 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12968 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12969 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12970 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971
12972http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012973 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12974 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12976 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012978method : integer + string
12979 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12980 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12981 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12982 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12983 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12984 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12985 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987 ACL derivatives :
12988 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012990 Example :
12991 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12992 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12993 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012995path : string
12996 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12997 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12998 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12999 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13000 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13001 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13002 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004 ACL derivatives :
13005 path : exact string match
13006 path_beg : prefix match
13007 path_dir : subdir match
13008 path_dom : domain match
13009 path_end : suffix match
13010 path_len : length match
13011 path_reg : regex match
13012 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013013
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013014query : string
13015 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13016 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13017 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13018 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13019 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13020 which stops before the question mark.
13021
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013022req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13023 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13024 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13025 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13026 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028req.ver : string
13029req_ver : string (deprecated)
13030 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13031 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13032 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013034 ACL derivatives :
13035 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013037res.comp : boolean
13038 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13039 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13040 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042res.comp_algo : string
13043 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13044 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13045 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047res.cook([<name>]) : string
13048scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13049 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13050 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13051 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053 ACL derivatives :
13054 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13057scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13058 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13059 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13060 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13063scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13064 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13065 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13066 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13069 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13070 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13071 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13072 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13073 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13074 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13075 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13076 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13077 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13080 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13081 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13082 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13083 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13084 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13087shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13088 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13089 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13090 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13091 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13092 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13093 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13094 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13095 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097 ACL derivatives :
13098 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13099 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13100 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13101 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13102 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13103 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13104 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13105 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13106
13107res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13108shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13109 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13110 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13111 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13112 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13113 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013115res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13116shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13117 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13118 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13119 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13120 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13121 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13122 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013123
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013124res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13125 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13126 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13127 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13128 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013130res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13131shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13132 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13133 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13134 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13135 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13136 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13137 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139res.ver : string
13140resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13141 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13142 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144 ACL derivatives :
13145 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13148 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13149 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
13150 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
13151 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013153 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13154 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013158status : integer
13159 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13160 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13161 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163url : string
13164 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13165 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13166 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13167 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13168 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13169 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13170 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172 ACL derivatives :
13173 url : exact string match
13174 url_beg : prefix match
13175 url_dir : subdir match
13176 url_dom : domain match
13177 url_end : suffix match
13178 url_len : length match
13179 url_reg : regex match
13180 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013182url_ip : ip
13183 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13184 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13185 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13186 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13187 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13188 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13189 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191url_port : integer
13192 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13193 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13194 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13195 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013196
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013197urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13198url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13200 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013201 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13202 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13203 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13204 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013205 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13206 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013207 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13208 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210 ACL derivatives :
13211 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13212 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13213 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13214 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13215 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13216 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13217 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13218 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013219
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221 Example :
13222 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13223 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13224 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13225 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013226
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013227urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013228 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13229 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13230 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013231
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132337.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013234---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013236Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13237every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013238order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013240ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13241---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013242FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013243HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013244HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13245HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013246HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13247HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13248HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13249HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13250LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013251METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13252METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13253METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13254METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13255METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13256METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013257RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013258REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013259TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013260WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13261---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013262
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132648. Logging
13265----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013266
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013267One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13268provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13269very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13270provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13271state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013272to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013273headers.
13274
13275In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13276about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13277send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13278
13279 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13280 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13281 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13282 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13283 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013284 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13285 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013286
13287The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13288allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13289as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13290while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13291real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13292delay.
13293
13294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132958.1. Log levels
13296---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013297
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013298TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013299source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013300HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13301in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13302track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13303syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13304about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013305
13306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133078.2. Log formats
13308----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013309
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013310HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013311and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13312slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13313options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013314
13315 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13316 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13317 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13318 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13319 extents.
13320
13321 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13322 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13323 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13324 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13325 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13326
13327 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13328 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13329 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13330 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13331 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13332
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013333 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13334 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13335 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13336 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13337
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013338 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013340Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13341specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13342field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13343servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13344always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13345identifier.
13346
13347Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13348 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13349 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13350 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13351 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13352
13353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133548.2.1. Default log format
13355-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013356
13357This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13358as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13359format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13360
13361 Example :
13362 listen www
13363 mode http
13364 log global
13365 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13366
13367 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13368 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13369 (www/HTTP)
13370
13371 Field Format Extract from the example above
13372 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13373 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13374 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13375 4 'to' to
13376 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13377 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13378
13379Detailed fields description :
13380 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13381 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13382 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13383 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13384 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13385 and processed the connection.
13386 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13387
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013388In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13389"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13390connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13391
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013392It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13393will eventually disappear.
13394
13395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133968.2.2. TCP log format
13397---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013398
13399The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13400is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13401information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13402counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13403emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13404environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13405the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13406sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013407specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13408not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13409fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13410marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013411
13412 Example :
13413 frontend fnt
13414 mode tcp
13415 option tcplog
13416 log global
13417 default_backend bck
13418
13419 backend bck
13420 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13421
13422 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13423 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13424 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13425
13426 Field Format Extract from the example above
13427 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13428 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13429 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13430 4 frontend_name fnt
13431 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13432 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13433 7 bytes_read* 212
13434 8 termination_state --
13435 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13436 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13437
13438Detailed fields description :
13439 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013440 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13441 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13442 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13443 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13444 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013445
13446 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013447 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13448 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13449 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013450
13451 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13452 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13453 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13454 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13455
13456 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13457 and processed the connection.
13458
13459 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13460 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13461 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13462 applications.
13463
13464 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13465 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13466 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13467 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13468 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13469
13470 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13471 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13472 See "Timers" below for more details.
13473
13474 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13475 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13476 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13477 "Timers" below for more details.
13478
13479 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013480 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013481 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13482 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13483 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13484 details.
13485
13486 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13487 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13488 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13489 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13490 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13491
13492 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13493 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13494 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13495 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13496 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13497 for more details.
13498
13499 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013500 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013501 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13502 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13503 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013504 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013505
13506 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13507 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13508 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13509 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13510 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13511 caused by a denial of service attack.
13512
13513 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13514 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13515 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13516 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13517 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13518 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13519 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13520 denial of service attack.
13521
13522 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13523 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13524 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13525 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13526 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13527 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13528 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13529 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13530 be processed than on other servers.
13531
13532 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13533 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13534 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13535 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13536 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13537 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13538 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13539 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13540 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13541 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13542 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13543 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13544 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13545
13546 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13547 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13548 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13549 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13550 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13551 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13552 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13553 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13554
13555 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13556 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13557 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13558 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13559 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13560 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13561 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13562 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13563 occurs.
13564
13565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135668.2.3. HTTP log format
13567----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013568
13569The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13570is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13571the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13572are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13573emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13574generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13575"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13576which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013577frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13578is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013579
13580Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13581slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13582with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13583
13584 Example :
13585 frontend http-in
13586 mode http
13587 option httplog
13588 log global
13589 default_backend bck
13590
13591 backend static
13592 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13593
13594 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13595 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13596 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013597 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013598
13599 Field Format Extract from the example above
13600 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13601 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13602 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13603 4 frontend_name http-in
13604 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13605 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13606 7 status_code 200
13607 8 bytes_read* 2750
13608 9 captured_request_cookie -
13609 10 captured_response_cookie -
13610 11 termination_state ----
13611 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13612 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13613 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13614 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13615 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013616
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013617
13618Detailed fields description :
13619 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013620 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13621 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13622 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13623 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13624 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013625
13626 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013627 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13628 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13629 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013630
13631 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13632 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13633 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13634 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13635 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13636
13637 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13638 and processed the connection.
13639
13640 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13641 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13642 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13643
13644 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13645 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13646 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13647 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13648 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13649 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13650
13651 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13652 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13653 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13654 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13655 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13656 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13657
13658 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13659 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13660 See "Timers" below for more details.
13661
13662 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13663 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13664 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13665 below for more details.
13666
13667 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13668 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13669 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13670 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13671 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13672 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13673 for more details.
13674
13675 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013676 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013677 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13678 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13679 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13680 details.
13681
13682 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13683 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13684 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13685
13686 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13687 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13688 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13689 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13690 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13691 overflowing.
13692
13693 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13694 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13695 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13696 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13697 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13698 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13699 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13700 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13701
13702 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13703 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13704 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13705 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13706 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13707 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13708 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13709 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13710
13711 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13712 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13713 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13714 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13715 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13716 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13717 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13718
13719 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013720 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013721 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13722 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13723 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013724 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013725 system.
13726
13727 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13728 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13729 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13730 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13731 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13732 caused by a denial of service attack.
13733
13734 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13735 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13736 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13737 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13738 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13739 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13740 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13741 denial of service attack.
13742
13743 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13744 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13745 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13746 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13747 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13748 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13749 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13750 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13751 processed than on other servers.
13752
13753 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13754 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13755 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13756 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13757 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13758 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13759 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13760 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13761 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13762 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13763 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13764 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13765 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13766
13767 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13768 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13769 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13770 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13771 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13772 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13773 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13774 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13775
13776 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13777 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13778 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13779 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13780 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13781 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13782 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13783 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13784 occurs.
13785
13786 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13787 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13788 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13789 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13790 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13791 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13792 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13793 cookies" below for more details.
13794
13795 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13796 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13797 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13798 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13799 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13800 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13801 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13802 and cookies" below for more details.
13803
13804 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13805 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13806 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13807 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13808 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13809 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13810 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13811 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13812
13813
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200138148.2.4. Custom log format
13815------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013816
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013817The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013818mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013819
13820HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13821Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13822separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13823prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13824
13825Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13826variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13827string formats ("Q").
13828
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013829If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013830as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013831less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13832the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13833
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013834Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013835In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013836in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013837
13838Flags are :
13839 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013840 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013841
13842 Example:
13843
13844 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13845 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13846
13847At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13848
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013849 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13850 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013851
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013852the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013853
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013854 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013855 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013856 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013857
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013858and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13859
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013860 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013861 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13862
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013863Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13864
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013865 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013866 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013867 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13868 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13869 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013870 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13871 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13872 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013873 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013874 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13875 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13876 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13877 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013878 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013879 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013880 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013881 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013882 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013883 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13884 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013885 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013886 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13887 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013888 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013889 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13890 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013891 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13892 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13893 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013894 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013895 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13896 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013897 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013898 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13899 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13900 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013901 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013902 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013903 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13904 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13905 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13906 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013907 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013908 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013909 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013910 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013911 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013912 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013913 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13914 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13915 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013916 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013917 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13918 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013919 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013920 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013921 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013922 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013923
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013924 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013925
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013926
139278.2.5. Error log format
13928-----------------------
13929
13930When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13931protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13932By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13933"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13934will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13935logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13936
13937The format looks like this :
13938
13939 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13940 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13941 Connection error during SSL handshake
13942
13943 Field Format Extract from the example above
13944 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13945 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13946 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13947 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13948 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13949
13950These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13951failures.
13952
13953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139548.3. Advanced logging options
13955-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013956
13957Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13958just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13959options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13960for more information about their usage.
13961
13962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139638.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13964------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013965
13966It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13967haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13968commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13969monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13970ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13971
13972 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13973 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13974 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13975 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13976
13977 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13978 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13979 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013980 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013981 such as other load-balancers.
13982
13983 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13984 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13985 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13986
13987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139888.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13989----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013990
13991The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13992what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13993or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13994"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13995just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13996log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13997after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13998is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13999with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14000with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14001
14002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140038.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14004------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014005
14006Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14007for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14008"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14009retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14010raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14011a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14012file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14013you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14014"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14015
14016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140178.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14018--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014019
14020Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14021multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14022them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14023"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14024logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14025error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14026and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14027too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14028useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14029alternative.
14030
14031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140328.4. Timing events
14033------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014034
14035Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14036reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14037the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14038frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14039mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14040
14041 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14042 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14043 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14044 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14045 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14046
14047 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14048 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14049 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14050 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14051 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14052
14053 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14054 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14055 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14056 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14057 connection never established.
14058
14059 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14060 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14061 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14062 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14063 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14064 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14065 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14066 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14067 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14068 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14069 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14070
14071 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14072 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14073 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14074 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014075 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014076
14077 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14078
14079 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14080 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14081 negative.
14082
14083These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14084protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14085that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014086due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014087close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14088session has been aborted on timeout.
14089
14090Most common cases :
14091
14092 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14093 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14094 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14095 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14096 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14097 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14098 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14099 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14100 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014101 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14102 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14103 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014104
14105 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14106 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14107 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14108 of ms on remote networks.
14109
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014110 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14111 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14112 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014113
14114 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14115 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14116 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14117 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14118 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14119 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14120 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14121 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14122 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14123 to the server until another one is released.
14124
14125Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14126
14127 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14128 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14129 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14130
14131 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14132 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14133 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14134
14135 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14136 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14137 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14138 flags.
14139
14140 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14141 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14142 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14143 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14144 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14145 the client connection was maintained open.
14146
14147 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014148 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014149 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14150 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14151
14152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141538.5. Session state at disconnection
14154-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014155
14156TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14157"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
141582-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14159each of which has a special meaning :
14160
14161 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14162 session to terminate :
14163
14164 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14165
14166 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14167 server explicitly refused it.
14168
14169 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14170 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14171 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14172 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014173 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14174
14175 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14176 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014177
14178 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14179 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14180 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14181 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14182 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14183
14184 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14185 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14186 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14187 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14188 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14189
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014190 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14191 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14192
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014193 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14194 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14195 backup connections when going up.
14196
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014197 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14198
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014199 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14200 send or receive data.
14201
14202 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14203 send or receive data.
14204
14205 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14206 with nothing left in the buffers.
14207
14208 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14209
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014210 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014211 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14212
14213 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14214 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14215 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14216 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14217 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14218
14219 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14220 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14221
14222 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14223 server (HTTP only).
14224
14225 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14226
14227 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14228 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14229 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14230
14231 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14232 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14233 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14234
14235 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14236
14237 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14238 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14239
14240 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14241 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14242 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14243
14244 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14245 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014246 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14247 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014248
14249 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14250 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14251 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14252 another server.
14253
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014254 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014255 server.
14256
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014257 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14258 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14259 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14260 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14261
14262 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14263 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14264 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14265 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14266
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014267 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14268 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14269 "use-server" rule).
14270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014271 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14272
14273 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14274 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14275
14276 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14277
14278 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14279 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14280 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14281
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014282 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14283 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014284 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014285 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14286 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14287
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014288 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14289
14290 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14291 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14292
14293 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14294
14295 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14296
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014297The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14298was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014299helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14300starvation, attacks, etc...
14301
14302The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14303alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14304easier finding and understanding.
14305
14306 Flags Reason
14307
14308 -- Normal termination.
14309
14310 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14311 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14312 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14313 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14314
14315 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14316 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14317 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14318 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14319 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14320 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014321
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014322 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14323 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014324 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014325
14326 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14327 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14328 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14329
14330 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14331 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14332 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14333 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14334 the server takes too long to respond.
14335
14336 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14337 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14338 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14339 long a time to respond.
14340
14341 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14342 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14343 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14344 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014345 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14346 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014347
14348 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14349 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14350 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14351 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14352 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014353 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014354 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14355 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14356 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14357 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14358 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14359 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14360 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14361 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14362 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14363 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14364 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14365 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014366
14367 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14368 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014369 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14370 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14371 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14372 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014373
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014374 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14375 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014377 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014378 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14379 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14380 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14381 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14382 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14383
14384 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14385 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14386 503 or 504 here.
14387
14388 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14389 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14390 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14391 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14392 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14393
14394 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14395 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014396 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014397 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14398 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14399
14400 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14401 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14402 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14403 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14404 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14405 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14406 between haproxy and the server.
14407
14408 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14409 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14410 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14411 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14412 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14413 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14414 solution is to fix the application.
14415
14416 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14417 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14418 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14419 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14420 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14421 external attacks.
14422
14423 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14424 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014425 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014426 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14427 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14428
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014429 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14430 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14431 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014432 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14433 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014434
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014435 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14436 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14437 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14438 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014439 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14440 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14441 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14442 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14443 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014444
14445 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14446 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14447 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14448 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14449
14450 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14451 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14452 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14453 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14454
14455 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14456 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14457 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14458 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14459
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014460The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14461persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14462important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14463re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14464
14465 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14466
14467 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14468 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14469 set on a GET request.
14470
14471 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14472 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014473 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014474 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14475
14476 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14477 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14478 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14479
14480 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14481 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14482 already got a cookie.
14483
14484 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14485 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14486 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14487 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14488 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14489
14490 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14491 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14492 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14493
14494 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14495 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14496 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14497
14498 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14499 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14500
14501 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14502 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14503 then advertised in the response.
14504
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145068.6. Non-printable characters
14507-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014508
14509In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14510consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14511converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14512prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14513being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14514escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14515is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14516'}' when logging headers.
14517
14518Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14519issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14520containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14521
14522Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14523the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14524performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14525
14526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145278.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14528---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014529
14530Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14531achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014532section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014533cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14534the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14535the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014536locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014537not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14538user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14539a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14540wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14541
14542 Examples :
14543 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14544 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14545
14546 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14547 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14548
14549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145508.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14551---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014552
14553Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14554proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14555the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14556server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14557
14558Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14559response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014560section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014561
14562It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014563time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14564appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014565are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14566and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14567follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14568request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14569in the logs.
14570
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014571As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14572frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14573an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014575 Example :
14576 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14577 listen proxy-out
14578 mode http
14579 option httplog
14580 option logasap
14581 log global
14582 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14583
14584 # log the name of the virtual server
14585 capture request header Host len 20
14586
14587 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14588 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14589
14590 # log the beginning of the referrer
14591 capture request header Referer len 20
14592
14593 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14594 capture response header Server len 20
14595
14596 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14597 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14598
14599 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14600 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14601
14602 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14603 capture response header Via len 20
14604
14605 # log the URL location during a redirection
14606 capture response header Location len 20
14607
14608 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14609 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14610 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14611 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14612 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14613
14614 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14615 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14616 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14617 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014618 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014619
14620 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14621 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14622 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14623 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14624 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014625 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014626
14627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146288.9. Examples of logs
14629---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014630
14631These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14632them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14633reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14634
14635 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14636 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14637 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14638
14639 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14640 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14641
14642 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14643 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14644 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14645
14646 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14647 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14648
14649 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14650 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14651 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14652
14653 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014654 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014655 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14656 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14657
14658 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14659 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14660 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14661
14662 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14663 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014664 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014665 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14666 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14667 to return the 502 and not the server.
14668
14669 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014670 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014671
14672 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14673 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14674 Nothing was sent to any server.
14675
14676 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14677 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14678
14679 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14680 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14681 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14682 send a 408 return code to the client.
14683
14684 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14685 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14686
14687 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14688 5 seconds ("c----").
14689
14690 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14691 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014692 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014693
14694 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014695 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014696 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14697 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14698 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14699 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14700 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014701
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147039. Statistics and monitoring
14704----------------------------
14705
14706It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14707mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14708CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14709Unix socket.
14710
14711
147129.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014713---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014714
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014715The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014716page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14717begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14718represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14719use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14720('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14721(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14722text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14723do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14724use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014725
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014726In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14727that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14728S (Servers).
14729
14730 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14731 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14732 any name for server/listener)
14733 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14734 number queued without a server assigned.
14735 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14736 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14737 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14738 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14739 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14740 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14741 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14742 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14743 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14744 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14745 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14746 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14747 "option checkcache".
14748 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14749 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14750 - read error from the client
14751 - client timeout
14752 - client closed connection
14753 - various bad requests from the client.
14754 - request was tarpitted.
14755 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14756 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14757 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14758 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14759 active servers).
14760 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14761 Some other errors are:
14762 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14763 - failure applying filters to the response.
14764 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14765 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14766 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14767 switched away from.
14768 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014769 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14770 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14771 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014772 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14773 the server is up.)
14774 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14775 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14776 counters for each server.
14777 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14778 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14779 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14780 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14781 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14782 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14783 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14784 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14785 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14786 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14787 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14788 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14789 of times that server was selected.
14790 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14791 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14792 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14793 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14794 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14795 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014796 UNK -> unknown
14797 INI -> initializing
14798 SOCKERR -> socket error
14799 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014800 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014801 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14802 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14803 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14804 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14805 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14806 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14807 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14808 disable-on-404
14809 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14810 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14811 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014812 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14813 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14814 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14815 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14816 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14817 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14818 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14819 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14820 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14821 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14822 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14823 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14824 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14825 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14826 (inc. in eresp)
14827 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14828 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14829 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14830 (CPU/BW limit)
14831 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14832 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14833 server/backend
14834 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14835 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14836 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14837 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14838 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14839 (0 for TCP)
14840 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14841 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014842
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148449.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014845-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014846
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014847The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14848necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14849A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14850issuing commands by hand :
14851
14852 global
14853 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14854 stats timeout 2m
14855
14856It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14857the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14858never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14859situations :
14860
14861 global
14862 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14863 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14864 stats timeout 2m
14865
14866To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14867swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14868to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14869syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14870
14871 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14872 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14873
14874The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14875script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14876for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14877
14878The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14879that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14880editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14881(eg: watch a counter).
14882
14883The socket supports two operation modes :
14884 - interactive
14885 - non-interactive
14886
14887The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14888this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14889sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14890mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14891commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14892example :
14893
14894 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14895
14896The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14897entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14898for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14899sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14900"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14901after processing the last command of the same line.
14902
14903For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14904"prompt" command :
14905
14906 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14907 prompt
14908 > show info
14909 ...
14910 >
14911
14912Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14913delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14914that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14915parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014916
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014917It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14918on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14919own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014920
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014921The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14922If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14923all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14924it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14925
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014926add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014927 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14928 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14929 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14930 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014931
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014932add map <map> <key> <value>
14933 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14934 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014935 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14936 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14937 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014939clear counters
14940 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14941 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14942 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14943 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14944 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14945
14946clear counters all
14947 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14948 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14949 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14950
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014951clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014952 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14953 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14954 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014955
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014956clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014957 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14958 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14959 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014960
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014961clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14962 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14963
14964 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14965 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14966 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14967 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14968 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14969 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14970
14971 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14972
14973 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14974 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14975 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14976 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14977 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14978 the ACLs :
14979
14980 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14981 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14982 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14983 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14984 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14985 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14986
14987 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014988 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14989 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014990
14991 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014992 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014993 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014994 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14995 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14996 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14997 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014998
14999 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15000
15001 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015002 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015003 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15004 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015005 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15006 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15007 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015008
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015009del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
15010 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015011 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
15012 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15013 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
15014 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015015
15016del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015017 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015018 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
15019 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15020 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
15021 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015022
15023disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015024 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
15025
15026 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15027 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15028 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15029 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15030 re-enabled using enable agent.
15031
15032 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15033 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15034 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15035 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15036 otherwise unchanged.
15037
15038 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15039 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15040 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15041
15042 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15043 level "admin".
15044
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015045disable frontend <frontend>
15046 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15047 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15048 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15049 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15050 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15051 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15052 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15053 on the stats page.
15054
15055 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15056 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15057
15058 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15059 level "admin".
15060
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015061disable health <backend>/<server>
15062 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15063 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15064 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15065 agent check forces it down.
15066
15067 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15068 level "admin".
15069
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015070disable server <backend>/<server>
15071 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15072 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15073 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15074 during the maintenance.
15075
15076 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15077 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15078
15079 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015080 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015081
15082 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15083 level "admin".
15084
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015085enable agent <backend>/<server>
15086 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15087
15088 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15089 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15090
15091 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15092 level "admin".
15093
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015094enable frontend <frontend>
15095 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15096 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15097 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15098 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15099 which was disabled.
15100
15101 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15102 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15103
15104 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15105 level "admin".
15106
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015107enable health <backend>/<server>
15108 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15109 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15110
15111 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15112 level "admin".
15113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015114enable server <backend>/<server>
15115 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15116 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15117
15118 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015119 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015120
15121 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15122 level "admin".
15123
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015124get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015125get acl <acl> <value>
15126 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15127 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15128 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15129 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15130 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015131
15132 The first two words are:
15133
15134 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15135 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15136 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15137
15138 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15139
15140 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15141
15142 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15143
15144 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15145 interpretation of the case.
15146
15147 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15148 useful with regular expressions.
15149
15150 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15151 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15152
15153 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15154 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15155 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15156
15157 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15158
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015159get weight <backend>/<server>
15160 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15161 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15162 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15163 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15164 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015165 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015166
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015167help
15168 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15169 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015170
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015171prompt
15172 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15173 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15174 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15175 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15176 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15177 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15178 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15179 command.
15180
15181quit
15182 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015183
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015184set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015185 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15186 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15187 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015188
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015189set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015190 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15191 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15192 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15193 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15194 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015195 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15196 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15197
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015198set maxconn global <maxconn>
15199 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15200 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15201 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15202 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15203 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15204 setting.
15205
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015206set rate-limit connections global <value>
15207 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15208 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15209 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15210 is passed in number of connections per second.
15211
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015212set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15213 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15214 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015215 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15216 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015217
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015218set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15219 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15220 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15221 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15222 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15223
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015224set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15225 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15226 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15227 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15228 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15229 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15230
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015231set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15232 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15233
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015234set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15235 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15236 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15237 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15238
15239set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15240 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15241 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15242 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15243
15244set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15245 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15246 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15247 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15248 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15249 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15250 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15251 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15252 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15253
15254set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15255 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15256 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15257
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015258set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15259 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15260 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15261 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15262 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15263
15264 Example:
15265 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15266 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15267 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15268 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15269
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015270set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15271 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15272 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15273 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15274 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15275 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15276
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015277set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015278 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15279 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15280 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15281 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015282 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15283 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015284
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015285set timeout cli <delay>
15286 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15287 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15288 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15289
15290set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15291 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15292 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015293 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15294 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15295 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15296 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15297 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15298 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15299 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15300 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15301 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15302 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15303 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15304 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15305 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015306
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015307show errors [<iid>]
15308 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15309 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015310 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15311 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15312 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015313
15314 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15315 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15316 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15317 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15318 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15319 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15320 are reported too.
15321
15322 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15323 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15324 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15325 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15326 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15327 code.
15328
15329 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15330 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15331 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15332 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15333 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15334 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15335 line.
15336
15337 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015338 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15339 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015340 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15341 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15342
15343 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15344 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15345 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15346 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15347 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15348 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15349 00204+ minal\r\n
15350 00211 \r\n
15351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015352 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015353 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15354 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15355 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15356 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15357 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15358 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015359
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015360show info
15361 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15362
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015363show map [<map>]
15364 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015365 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15366 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15367 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15368 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15369 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15370 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015371
15372show acl [<acl>]
15373 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015374 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15375 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15376 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15377 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15378 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015379
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015380show pools
15381 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15382 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15383 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15384 the pools.
15385
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015386show sess
15387 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015388 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15389 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15390
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015391show sess <id>
15392 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15393 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15394 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15395 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15396 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015397 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15398 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15399
15400 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15401 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015402
15403show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15404 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15405 possible to dump only selected items :
15406 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15407 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15408 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15409 for example:
15410 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15411 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15412 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15413
15414 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015415 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15416 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015417 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15418 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15419 Nbproc: 1
15420 Process_num: 1
15421 (...)
15422
15423 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15424 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15425 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15426 (...)
15427 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15428
15429 $
15430
15431 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15432 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15433 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15434 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015435 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015436
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015437show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15438 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15439 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15440 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15441 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15442 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15443 cname: number of CNAME responses
15444 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15445 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15446 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15447 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15448 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15449 other: any other DNS errors
15450 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15451 too_big: too big response
15452 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15453
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015454show table
15455 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15456 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15457 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15458 entries currently in use.
15459
15460 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015461 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015462 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15463 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015464
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015465show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015466 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15467 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15468 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015469 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15470
15471 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15472 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15473 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15474 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15475 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15476
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015477 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15478 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15479 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15480 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15481 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15482 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15483
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015484
15485 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015486 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15487 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015488
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015489 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015490 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015491 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015492 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15493 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15494 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15495 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015496
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015497 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015498 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015499 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15500 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015501
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015502 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15503 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015504 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015505 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15506 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015507
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015508 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15509 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015510 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015511 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15512 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15513
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015514 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15515 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15516 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15517 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15518 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15519
15520 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15521 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15522 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015523 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15524 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015525 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15526 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015527
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015528show tls-keys
15529 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15530 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15531 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15532
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015533shutdown frontend <frontend>
15534 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15535 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15536 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15537 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15538 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15539 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15540 once it is terminated.
15541
15542 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15543 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15544
15545 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15546 level "admin".
15547
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015548shutdown session <id>
15549 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15550 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15551 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15552 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15553 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15554 flag in the logs.
15555
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015556shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015557 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15558 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15559 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15560 'K' flag in the logs.
15561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015562/*
15563 * Local variables:
15564 * fill-column: 79
15565 * End:
15566 */